LICENSES: Update GFDL invariant text to match official wording
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
627 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
628
629 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
630 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
631 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
734 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
735 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
736 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
737 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
738 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
739 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
740 @end enumerate
741 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
742
743 @quotation Note
744 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
745 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
746 @end quotation
747
748 @section Simple setup, no customization
749
750 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
751 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
752 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
753 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
754 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
755
756 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
757 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
758 the server with some variation of one of the following:
759
760 @example
761 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
762 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
763 @end example
764
765 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
766 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
767 If all goes well you'll see output something like
768
769 @example
770 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
771 For bug reports, read
772 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
773 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
774 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
775 @end example
776
777 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
778 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
779 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
780
781 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
782
783 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
784 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
785 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
786 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
787 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
788 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
789 ensure that this always succeeds.
790 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
791 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
792 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
793 and then shut down without acting as a server.
794
795 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
796 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
797 those channels.
798
799 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
800 the @option{-d} option.
801
802 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
803 @option{-c} command line switch.
804
805 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
806 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
807 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
808 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
809 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
810 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
811 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
812
813 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
814 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
815
816 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
817 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
818 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
819 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
820
821 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
822 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
823
824 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
825 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
826 and start the OpenOCD server.
827 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
828 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
829 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
830 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
831
832 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
833
834 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
835 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
836 and a USB cable on the other.
837 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
838 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
839
840 @enumerate
841 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
842 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
843 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
844 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
845 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
846 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
847 debugging host.
848
849 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
850 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
851 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
852 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
853 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
854
855 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
856 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
857 with 1.2 Volt boards.
858
859 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
860 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
861 ways to connect the cable.
862 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
863 Be sure it's firmly connected.
864
865 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
866 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
867 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
868 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
869 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
870 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
871 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
872 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
873
874 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
875 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
876 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
877 but are tedious to set up.
878 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
879 adapter signals to the right board pins.
880
881 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
882 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
883 you are using to run OpenOCD.
884 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
885
886 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
887 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
888 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
889 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
890
891 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
892 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
893 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
894
895 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
896 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
897 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
898 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
899
900 @end enumerate
901
902 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
903 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
904 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
905
906 @section Project Directory
907
908 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
909
910 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
911 single directory for your work with a given board.
912 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
913 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
914 files accessed through semihosting,
915 and for code you upload to the target board.
916 It is also the natural place to write files,
917 such as log files and data you download from the board.
918
919 @section Configuration Basics
920
921 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
922 a variety of ways you can mix them.
923 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
924
925 @itemize
926 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
927 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
928 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
929 @end itemize
930
931 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
932 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
933 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
934
935 @example
936 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
937
938 # GDB can also flash my flash!
939 gdb_memory_map enable
940 gdb_flash_program enable
941
942 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
943 @end example
944
945 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
946
947 @example
948 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
949 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
950 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
951 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
952 @end example
953
954 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
955 each supporting a different development task.
956 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
957 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
958
959 @quotation Important
960 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
961 problems with how it treats variables.
962 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
963 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
964 that can be tested in a later script.
965 @end quotation
966
967 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
968 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
969 to simplify your work.
970
971 @section User Config Files
972 @cindex config file, user
973 @cindex user config file
974 @cindex config file, overview
975
976 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
977 in one place.
978 One of the following will match your situation best:
979
980 @itemize
981 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
982 provided by someone else.
983 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
984 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
985 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
986 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
987 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
988 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
989
990 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
991 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
992
993 @enumerate
994 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
995 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
996 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
997 @end enumerate
998
999 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
1000 The first is an interface config file.
1001 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
1002 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1003 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1004 meet your deadline:
1005
1006 @example
1007 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1008 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1009 @end example
1010
1011 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1012 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1013 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1014 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1015
1016 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1017 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1018 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1019 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1020 target and board
1021 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1023
1024 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1025 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1026 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1027 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1028
1029 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1030 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1031 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1032 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1033 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1034
1035 @quotation Note
1036 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1037 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1038 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1039 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1040 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1041 @end quotation
1042
1043 @item
1044 You may need to write some C code.
1045 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1046 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1047 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1048 a new chip architecture.
1049 @end itemize
1050
1051 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1052 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1053 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1054
1055 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1056 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1057 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1058 @itemize
1059
1060 @item
1061 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1062 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1063 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1064 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1065
1066 @item
1067 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1068 @cindex vector_catch
1069 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1070 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1071 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1072 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1073 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1074 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1075
1076 @item
1077 You might need to override some defaults.
1078 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1079 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1080
1081 @item
1082 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1083 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1084 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1085 @end itemize
1086
1087 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1088
1089 A few project-specific utility
1090 routines may well speed up your work.
1091 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1092
1093 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1094 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1095 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1096 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1097 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1098 may help:
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1103 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1104 # Leave the CPU halted.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1108 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1109
1110 # Start running.
1111 resume 0x20000000
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1116 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1117 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1118 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1119 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1120
1121 @example
1122 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1123 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1124 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1125 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1126 reset init
1127
1128 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1129 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1130 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1132 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1133 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1134 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1135
1136 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1137 reset run
1138 @}
1139 @end example
1140
1141 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1142 from NAND.
1143 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1144 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1145 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1146
1147 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1148 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1149
1150 @section Target Software Changes
1151
1152 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1153 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1154 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1155 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1156 handling issues like:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159
1160 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1161 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1162 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1163 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1164 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1165 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1166 your debug sessions.
1167
1168 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1169 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1170 That might however be your only option.
1171
1172 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1173 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1174 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1175 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1176 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1177 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1178 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1179 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1180 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1181 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1182 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1183 instead of the whole thing.
1184 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1185 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1188 @cindex ARM semihosting
1189 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1190 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1191 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1192 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1193 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1194 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1195 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1196 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1197 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1198 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1199 NAND or SPI flash.
1200
1201 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1202 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1203 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1204 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1205 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1206
1207 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1208 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1209 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1210 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1211 registers which can be used to change various features including
1212 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1213 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1214 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1215 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1216 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1217
1218 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1219 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1220 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1221 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1222 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1223
1224 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1225 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1226 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1227 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1228 early code execution can be debugged
1229 or firmware can be replaced.
1230
1231 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1232 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1233 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1234 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1235 operations like writing to memory.)
1236
1237 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1238 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1239 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1240 various kinds of message.
1241 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1242
1243 @end itemize
1244
1245 @section Target Hardware Setup
1246
1247 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1248 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1249 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1250 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1251 working with.}
1252
1253 Common issues include:
1254
1255 @itemize @bullet
1256
1257 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1258 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1259 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1260 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1261 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1262 or one from a daughtercard).
1263 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1264 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1265
1266 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1267 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1268 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1269 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1270 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1271 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1272
1273 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1274 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1275 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1276 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1277 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1278
1279
1280 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1281 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1282 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1283 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1284 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1285 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1286 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1287
1288 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1289 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1290 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1291 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1292 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1293
1294 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1295 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1296 used to start booting.
1297
1298 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1299 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1300 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1301 multiple audio codec chips).
1302 This interacts with software
1303 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1304 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1305 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1306 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1307 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1308 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1309 audio or video codecs are used.
1310
1311 @end itemize
1312
1313 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1314 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1315 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1316 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1317 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1318 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1319 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1320 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1321 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1322 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1323
1324
1325 @node Config File Guidelines
1326 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1327
1328 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1329 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1330 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1331 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1332
1333 You should find the following directories under
1334 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1335 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1336 @itemize @bullet
1337 @item @file{interface} ...
1338 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1339 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1340 @item @file{board} ...
1341 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1342 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1343
1344 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1345 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1346 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1347 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1348 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1349 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1350 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1351 a CPU and an FPGA.
1352 @item @file{target} ...
1353 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1354 on a chip
1355 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1356 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1357 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1358 the target config file defines all of them.
1359 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1360 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1361 @end itemize
1362
1363 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1364 file may override features in any of the above files by
1365 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1366 commands specific to their situation.
1367
1368 @section Interface Config Files
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1378 in use today with OpenOCD.
1379 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1380 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1381
1382 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1383 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1384 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1385 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1386 and need to provide a driver for it.
1387
1388 @section Board Config Files
1389 @cindex config file, board
1390 @cindex board config file
1391
1392 The user config file
1393 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1394
1395 @example
1396 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1397 @end example
1398
1399 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1400 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1401 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1402
1403 @enumerate
1404 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1405 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1406 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1407 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1408 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1409 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1410 @end enumerate
1411
1412 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1413 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1414 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1415 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1416
1417 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1418 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1419 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1420 configuration works.
1421
1422 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1423
1424 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1425 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1426 convention on how to use certain variables.
1427
1428 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1429 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1430 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1431 used at will within a target configuration file.
1432
1433 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1434 for a board with three chips:
1435
1436 @example
1437 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1438 set CHIPNAME network
1439 set ENDIAN big
1440 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1441 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1442 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1443 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1444
1445 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1446 set CHIPNAME video
1447 set ENDIAN little
1448 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1449 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1450 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1451 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1452
1453 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1454 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1455 unset ENDIAN
1456 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1457 @end example
1458
1459 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1460 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1461 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1462 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1463 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1464 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1465 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1466 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1467
1468 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1469 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1470 naming collisions.
1471
1472 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1473 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1474 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1475 up other clocks and peripherals.
1476
1477 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1478 @cindex variable names
1479
1480 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1481 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1482 one such chip (as shown above).
1483 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1484 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1485 to promote consistency and
1486 so that board files can override target defaults.
1487
1488 Inputs to target config files include:
1489
1490 @itemize @bullet
1491 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1492 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1493 tap identifier dotted names.
1494 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1495 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1496 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1497 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1498 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1499 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1500 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1501 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1502 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1503 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1504 @end itemize
1505
1506 Outputs from target config files include:
1507
1508 @itemize @bullet
1509 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1510 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1511 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1512 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1513 specific to that board and that target.
1514 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1515 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1516 @end itemize
1517
1518 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1519 @cindex event, reset-init
1520 @cindex reset-init handler
1521
1522 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1523 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1524 fully set up yet.
1525 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1526 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1527 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1528 handler is one of the most important.
1529
1530 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1531 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1532 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1533 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1534 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1535
1536 @quotation Note
1537 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1538 are included here.
1539 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1540 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1541 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1542 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1543 @end quotation
1544
1545 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1546 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1547 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1548 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1549 those as parameters.
1550 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1551 and disabling the watchdog.
1552 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1553 the next developer doing such work.
1554 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1555
1556 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1557 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1558 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1559 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1560
1561 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1562
1563 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1564 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1565 a low JTAG clock rate.
1566 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1567 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1568 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1569 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1570 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1571 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1572 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1573
1574 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1575 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1576 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1577 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1578 which might be less than that.
1579
1580 @quotation Warning
1581 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1582 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1583 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1584 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1585 @end quotation
1586
1587 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1588 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1589 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1590 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1591 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1592 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1593
1594 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1595 @subsection The init_board procedure
1596 @cindex init_board procedure
1597
1598 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1599 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1600 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1601 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1602 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1603 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1604 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1605 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1606 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1607 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1608 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1609 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1610
1611 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1612 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1613
1614 @example
1615 ### board_file.cfg ###
1616
1617 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1618 source [find target/target.cfg]
1619
1620 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1621 # enables fast on-board clock source
1622 # configures the chip to use it
1623 @}
1624
1625 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1626 proc init_board @{@} @{
1627 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1630 adapter speed 100
1631 @}
1632
1633 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1634 enable_fast_clock
1635 adapter speed 10000
1636 @}
1637 @}
1638 @end example
1639
1640 @section Target Config Files
1641 @cindex config file, target
1642 @cindex target config file
1643
1644 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1645 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1646 more target config files like this:
1647
1648 @example
1649 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1650 @end example
1651
1652 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1653 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1654 In summary the target files should contain
1655
1656 @enumerate
1657 @item Set defaults
1658 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1659 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1660 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1661 @item On-Chip flash
1662 @end enumerate
1663
1664 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1665 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1666 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1667
1668 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1669 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1670 can talk to the chip.
1671 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1672 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1673 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1674 and other processing engines.
1675
1676 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1677
1678 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1679 letting board config files express environment-specific
1680 differences in how things should be set up.
1681
1682 @example
1683 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1684 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1685 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1686 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1689 @}
1690
1691 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1692 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1693 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1694 @} else @{
1695 set _ENDIAN little
1696 @}
1697
1698 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1699 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1700 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1701 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1702 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1703 @} else @{
1704 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1705 @}
1706 @end example
1707 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1708
1709 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1710 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1711 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1712
1713 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1714 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1715 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1716
1717 @example
1718 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1719 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1720 @end example
1721
1722 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1723 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1724 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1725 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1726 for taps.
1727
1728 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1729 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1730 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1731 looks (in part) like this:
1732
1733 @example
1734 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1735 @end example
1736
1737 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1738 to source such a config file twice, with different
1739 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1740 it adds a different TAP each time.
1741
1742 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1743 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1744 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1745 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1746
1747 @example
1748 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1749 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1750 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1751 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1752 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1753 @end example
1754
1755 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1756 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1757
1758 @itemize
1759 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1760 plus a JRC to enable them
1761 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1762 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1763 is not currently used)
1764 @end itemize
1765
1766 @subsection Add CPU targets
1767
1768 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1769 GDB and other commands can use it.
1770 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1771 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1772 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1773 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1778 @end example
1779
1780 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1781 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1782 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1783 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1784 a work area if you can.
1785 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1786
1787 @example
1788 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1789 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1790 @end example
1791
1792 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1793 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1794 @cindex SMP
1795 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1796
1797 @example
1798 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1800 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1801 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1802 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1803 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1804 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1805 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1806 @end example
1807 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1808 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1809 @itemize @bullet
1810 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1811 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1812 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1813 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1814 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1815 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1816 @end itemize
1817
1818 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1819 command have been implemented.
1820 @itemize @bullet
1821 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1822 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1823 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1824 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1825 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1826 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1827 following example.
1828 @end itemize
1829
1830 @example
1831 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1833 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1837 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1839 > resume
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1843 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1847 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1848 @end example
1849
1850
1851 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1852
1853 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1854 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1855 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1856
1857 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1858 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1859 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1860 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1861 both signals.
1862
1863 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1864 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1865 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1866 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1867 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1868 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1869 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1870 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1871 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1872 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1873 not available.)
1874
1875 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1876 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1877 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1878 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1879 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1880 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1881 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1882 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1883
1884 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1885 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1886 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1887 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1888 slower clock than they will use later.
1889 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1890 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1891 than they will use later.
1892 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1893
1894 @quotation Important
1895 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1896 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1897 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1898 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1899 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1900 @end quotation
1901
1902 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1903 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1904 @cindex init_targets procedure
1905
1906 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1907 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1908 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1909 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1910 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1911 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1912 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1913 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1914 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1915
1916 @example
1917 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1918
1919 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1920 # basic initialization procedure ...
1921 @}
1922
1923 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1924 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1925 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1926 @}
1927
1928 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1929
1930 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1931
1932 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1933 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1934 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1935 @}
1936 @end example
1937
1938 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1939 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1940
1941 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1942
1943 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1944 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1945
1946 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1947 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1948 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1949
1950 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1951 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1952 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1953 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1954 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1955 events already assigned.
1956
1957 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1958
1959 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1960 special high speed download features - enable it.
1961
1962 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1963
1964 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1965 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1966 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1967 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1968 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1969 If you are using an external trace port,
1970 configure it in your board config file.
1971 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1972 configure it in your target config file.
1973
1974 @example
1975 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1976 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1977 @end example
1978
1979 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1980
1981 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1982
1983 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1984 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1985 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1986 the TARGET (chip) file.
1987
1988 Examples:
1989 @itemize @bullet
1990 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1991 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1992 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1993 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1994 @end itemize
1995
1996 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1997 @section Translating Configuration Files
1998 @cindex translation
1999 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2000 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2001 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2002 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2003 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2004 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2005
2006 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2007 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2008 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2009 convert other scripts later on.
2010
2011 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2012 replace job:
2013
2014 @example
2015 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2016 #
2017 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2018 #
2019 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2020 #
2021 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2022
2023 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2024 global TARGETNAME
2025
2026 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2027
2028 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2029 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2030 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2031 @}
2032 @end example
2033
2034
2035
2036 @node Server Configuration
2037 @chapter Server Configuration
2038 @cindex initialization
2039 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2040 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2041 supported.
2042
2043 @anchor{configurationstage}
2044 @section Configuration Stage
2045 @cindex configuration stage
2046 @cindex config command
2047
2048 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2049 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2050 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2051 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2052 inside startup scripts.
2053
2054 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2055 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2056 which may be issued interactively.
2057 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2058 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2059
2060 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2061 flash banks,
2062 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2063 and other basic setup.
2064 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2065 may access or activate TAPs.
2066 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2067 longer be issued.
2068
2069 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2070 @section Entering the Run Stage
2071
2072 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2073 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2074 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2076 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2077 You should see no errors at this point.
2078 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2079 commands you used to configure the server.
2080 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2081 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2082 on the scan chain.
2083
2084 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2085 become available.
2086 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2087 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2088 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2089 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2090 entry to the run stage.
2091
2092 @deffn {Config Command} init
2093 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2094 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2095 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2096 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2097 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2098 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2099
2100 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2101 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2102 configuration files and/or command line options.
2103
2104 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2105 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2106 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2107 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2108 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2112 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2113 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2114
2115 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2116 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2117 scan chain.
2118 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2119 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2120
2121 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2122 they return.
2123 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2124 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 @anchor{tcpipports}
2128 @section TCP/IP Ports
2129 @cindex TCP port
2130 @cindex server
2131 @cindex port
2132 @cindex security
2133 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2134 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2135 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2136
2137 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2138 access using one or more of these ports.
2139 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2140 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2141 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2142
2143 @anchor{gdb_port}
2144 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2145 @cindex GDB server
2146 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2147 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2148 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2149 the normal use cases.
2150
2151 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2152 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2153 disables the gdb server.
2154
2155 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2156 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2157
2158 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2159 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2160
2161 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2162 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2163 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2164
2165 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2166 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2167 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2168 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2169 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2170 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2171 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2172 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2173 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2174
2175 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2176 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2177 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2181 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2182 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2183 output from the Tcl engine.
2184 Intended as a machine interface.
2185 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2186 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2187 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2188 @end deffn
2189
2190 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2191 Specify or query the
2192 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2193 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2194 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2195 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2196 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2197 @end deffn
2198
2199 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2200 @section GDB Configuration
2201 @cindex GDB
2202 @cindex GDB configuration
2203 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2204 The ones listed here are static and global.
2205 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2206 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2207
2208 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2209 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2210 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2211 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2212 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2213 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2214 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2220 vFlash packet is received.
2221 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2226 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2227 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2228 for flash programming to work.
2229 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2230 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2234 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2235 by GDB memory read packets.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2237 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2238 @end deffn
2239
2240 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2241 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2242 packets report errors or not.
2243 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2244 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2248 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2249 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2253 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2254
2255 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2256 @end deffn
2257
2258 @anchor{eventpolling}
2259 @section Event Polling
2260
2261 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2262 where significant events can happen at any time.
2263 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2264 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2265 or to GDB.
2266
2267 Examples of such events include:
2268
2269 @itemize
2270 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2271 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2272 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2273 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2274 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2275 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2276 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2277 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2278 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2279 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2280 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2281 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2282 @end itemize
2283
2284 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2285 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2286 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2287 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2288 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2289
2290 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2291 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2292 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2293 to the various active targets.
2294 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2295 which is normally done in the background.
2296
2297 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2298 Poll the current target for its current state.
2299 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2300 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2301 specific information about the current state is printed.
2302 An optional parameter
2303 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2304
2305 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2306 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2307 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2308 @example
2309 > poll
2310 background polling: on
2311 target state: halted
2312 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2313 current mode: Supervisor
2314 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2315 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2316 >
2317 @end example
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2321 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2322 @cindex config file, interface
2323 @cindex interface config file
2324
2325 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2326 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2327 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2328
2329 @quotation Note
2330 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2331 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2332 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2333 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2334 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2335 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2336 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2337 @end quotation
2338
2339 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2340 through commands in an interface configuration
2341 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2342 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2343
2344 @example
2345 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2346 @end example
2347
2348 These commands tell
2349 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2350 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2351
2352 @example
2353 # jlink interface
2354 adapter driver jlink
2355 @end example
2356
2357 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2358
2359
2360 @section Adapter Configuration
2361
2362 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2363 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2364 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2365
2366 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2367 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2368 target.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2372 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2373 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2374 @end deffn
2375 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2376 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2377 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2378 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2379 the hardware can support.
2380 @end deffn
2381
2382
2383
2384 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2385 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2389 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2390 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2391 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2392 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2393 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2394 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2395
2396 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @section Interface Drivers
2400
2401 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2402 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2403 available at run time.
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2406 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2407 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2408 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2411 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2412 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2416 Displays status of RTCK option.
2417 Optionally sets that option first.
2418 @end deffn
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2422 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2423 This has one driver-specific command:
2424
2425 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2426 Logs some status
2427 @end deffn
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2431 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2432 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2433 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2434 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2435 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2439 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2440 or v2 (USB bulk).
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2443 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2444 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2445 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2446 @example
2447 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2448 @end example
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2452 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2453 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2457 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2458
2459 @itemize @minus
2460 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2461 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2462 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2463 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2464 @end itemize
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2468 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2469 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2470 interface string or for user class interface.
2471 @end deffn
2472
2473 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2474 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2475 @end deffn
2476 @end deffn
2477
2478 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2479 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2483 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2484 @end deffn
2485
2486 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2487 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2488 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2489
2490 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2491 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2492
2493 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2494 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2495
2496 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2497 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2498 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2499 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2500 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2501 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2502
2503 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2504 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2505 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2506 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2507 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2508
2509 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2510 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2511 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2512 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2513
2514 @itemize @minus
2515 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2516 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2517 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2518 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2519 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2520 switching data and direction as necessary
2521 @end itemize
2522
2523 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2524 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2525
2526 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2527 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2528 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2529 @example
2530 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2531 @end example
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2535 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2536 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2537 during device selection.
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2541 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2542 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2543 is connected to the host.
2544 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2545 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2546 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2550 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2551 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2552
2553 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2554 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2555 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2556 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2557 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2558
2559 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2563 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2564 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2568 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2569 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2570 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2571 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2572 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2573 and initially asserted reset signals.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2577 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2578 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2579 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2580 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2581 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2582 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2583 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2584 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2585 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2586 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2587
2588 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2589 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2590 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2591 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2592 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2593 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2594
2595 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2596 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2597 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2598 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2599 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2600 are always driven by the FTDI.
2601
2602 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2603 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2604 @var{name}.
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2608 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2609 @itemize @minus
2610 @item @option{0}, drive low
2611 @item @option{1}, drive high
2612 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2613 @end itemize
2614 @end deffn
2615
2616 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2617 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2618 @end deffn
2619
2620 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2621 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2622
2623 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2624 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2625 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2626 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2627 @itemize @minus
2628 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2629 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2630 @end itemize
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2634 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2635
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2639 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2640 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2641 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2642
2643 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2644 @itemize @minus
2645 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2646 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2647 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2648 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2649 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2650 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2651 @end itemize
2652
2653 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2654 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2655 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2656 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2657 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2658 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2659 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2660 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2661
2662 FT232R
2663 @itemize @minus
2664 @item bit 7 - RI
2665 @item bit 6 - DCD
2666 @item bit 5 - DSR
2667 @item bit 4 - DTR
2668 @item bit 3 - CTS
2669 @item bit 2 - RTS
2670 @item bit 1 - RXD
2671 @item bit 0 - TXD
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2675 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2676
2677 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2678 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2679 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2683 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2684 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2685 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2689 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2690 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2694 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2698 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2699 @end deffn
2700
2701 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2702 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2706 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2707 @end deffn
2708
2709 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2710 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2714 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2718 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2719 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2720 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2721 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2722 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2723 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2724 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2725 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2726 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2732 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2733 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2734 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2735
2736 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2737 processors which are being simulated.
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2740 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2741 sockets instead of TCP.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2745 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2746 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2750 something like:
2751
2752 @example
2753 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2754 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2755 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2756 @end example
2757
2758 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2759 named mysocket:
2760
2761 @example
2762 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2763 remote_bitbang_port 0
2764 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2769 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2770 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2771 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2774 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2775 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2776 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2777 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2781 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2782 default values are used.
2783 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2784 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2785 @example
2786 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2787 @end example
2788 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2789 @example
2790 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2791 @end example
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2795 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2796 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2797 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2798 target board.
2799
2800 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2801 @example
2802 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2803 reset_config srst_only
2804 @end example
2805 @end deffn
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2808 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2809 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2810 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2811 @end deffn
2812
2813 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2814 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2815 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2816 @end deffn
2817
2818 @end deffn
2819
2820 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2821 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2822 This has one driver-specific command:
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2825 Display either the address of the I/O port
2826 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2827 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2828 This is a write-once setting.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2833 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2834 transports.
2835
2836 @quotation Compatibility Note
2837 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2838 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2839 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2840 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2841 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2842 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2843 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2844 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2845 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2846 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2847 @end quotation
2848
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2850 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2851 states.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2854 Display free device internal memory.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2857 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2858 command version.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2861 Display the device configuration.
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2864 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2865 power state.
2866 @end deffn
2867 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2868 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2871 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2872 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2873 IP configuration.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2876 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2877 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2880 Reset the current configuration.
2881 @end deffn
2882 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2883 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2886 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2887 pairs.
2888
2889 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2890 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2891 @example
2892 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2893 @end example
2894 @end deffn
2895 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2896 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2897 pairs.
2898
2899 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2900 @example
2901 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2902 77a90000
2903 @end example
2904 @end deffn
2905 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2906 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2907 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2908 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2909 the serial number instead, if possible.
2910
2911 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2914 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2915 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2916
2917 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2922 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2923 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2924 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2925 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2926 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2927 configuration script.
2928
2929 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2930 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2931 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2932 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2933 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2934
2935 Known limitations:
2936 @itemize @bullet
2937 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2938 and 2.7 MHz.
2939 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2940 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2941 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2942 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2943 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2944 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2945 communications with the target.
2946 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2947 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2948 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2949 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2950 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2951 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2952 @end itemize
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2955 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2956 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2960 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2961 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2965 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2966 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2967 target as a side-effect.
2968 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2972 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2973 version, and target voltage.
2974 @end deffn
2975 @end deffn
2976
2977 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2978 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2979 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2980 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2981 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2982
2983 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2984 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2985 This is a write-once setting.
2986 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2987
2988 @itemize @minus
2989 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2990 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2991 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2992 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2993 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2994 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2995 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2996 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2997 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2998 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2999 some versions of
3000 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3001 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3002 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3003 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3004 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3005 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3006 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3007 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3008 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3009 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3010 @end itemize
3011 @end deffn
3012
3013 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3014 Display either the address of the I/O port
3015 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3016 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3017 This is a write-once setting.
3018
3019 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3020 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3021 you may encounter a problem.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3025 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3026 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3027 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3028 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3029 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3030
3031 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3032 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3033 @quotation Tip
3034 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3035 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3036 @example
3037 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3038 > adapter speed 500
3039 @end example
3040 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3041 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3042 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3043 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3044 large set of samples.
3045 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3046 @example
3047 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3048 @end example
3049 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3050 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3051
3052 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3053 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3054 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3055 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3056 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3057 be conservative.
3058 @end quotation
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3062 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3063 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3067 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3068
3069 @example
3070 adapter driver parport
3071 parport_port 0x278
3072 parport_cable wiggler
3073 @end example
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3077 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3079 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3080 @end deffn
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3084 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3088 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3089 @end deffn
3090
3091 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3092 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3093
3094 @quotation Note
3095 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3096 which are not currently documented here.
3097 @end quotation
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @anchor{hla_interface}
3101 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3102 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3103 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3104 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3105
3106 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3107 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3108 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3109 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3110 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3111 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3114 Currently Not Supported.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3118 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3122 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3126 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3130 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3131 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3132 @end deffn
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3137 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3138 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3139 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3140
3141 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3142 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3143 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3144 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3145
3146 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3147 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3148
3149 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3150 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3154 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3155 @end deffn
3156 @end deffn
3157
3158 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3159 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3160 @end deffn
3161
3162 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3163 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3167 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3168 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3169 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3170 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3173 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3174 XDS110 found will be used.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3178 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3179 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3180 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3181 @end deffn
3182
3183 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3184 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3185 version).
3186 @end deffn
3187 @end deffn
3188
3189 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3190 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3191 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3192 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3193 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3194
3195 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3198 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3199
3200 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3201 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3202
3203 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3204
3205 @end deffn
3206 @end deffn
3207
3208 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3209 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @quotation Note
3213 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3214 which are not currently documented here.
3215 @end quotation
3216
3217 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3218 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3219 No arguments: print status.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3223 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3224 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3225
3226 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3227 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3228 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3229 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3230 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3231 configuration on exit.
3232
3233 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3234 pinout.
3235
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3239 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3240 of the one which is most popular.
3241
3242 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3243
3244 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3245 pinout.
3246
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249
3250 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3251 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3252 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3253
3254 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3255 @end deffn
3256
3257
3258 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3259 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3260 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3261
3262 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265
3266 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3267 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3268 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3271 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3272 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3273
3274 @itemize @minus
3275 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3276 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3277 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3278 @end itemize
3279 @end deffn
3280
3281 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3282 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3283 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3284 @end deffn
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287
3288 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3289 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3290 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3291 DPI server interface.
3292
3293 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3294 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3298 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3299 @end deffn
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302
3303 @section Transport Configuration
3304 @cindex Transport
3305 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3306 and the debug adapter you are using,
3307 several transports may be available to
3308 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3309 @deffn Command {transport list}
3310 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3311 version of OpenOCD.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3315 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3316
3317 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3318 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3319 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3320 adapter's driver).
3321
3322 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3323 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3324 supported by the debug adapter.
3325
3326 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3327 transport, if any.
3328 @end deffn
3329
3330 @subsection JTAG Transport
3331 @cindex JTAG
3332 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3333 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3334 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3335 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3336 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3337 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3338
3339 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3340 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3341 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3342 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3343 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3344
3345 @subsection SWD Transport
3346 @cindex SWD
3347 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3348 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3349 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3350 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3351 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3352 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3353 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3354
3355 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3356 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3357 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3358 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3359 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3360
3361 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3362 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3363 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3364 expected to change.
3365 @end deffn
3366 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3367 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3368 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3369 No parameters: displays current settings.
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @subsection SPI Transport
3373 @cindex SPI
3374 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3375 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3376 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3377 solution for flash programming.
3378
3379 @anchor{swimtransport}
3380 @subsection SWIM Transport
3381 @cindex SWIM
3382 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3383 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3384 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3385 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3386
3387 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3388
3389 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3390
3391 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3392 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3393 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3394 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3395 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3396
3397 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3398 @section JTAG Speed
3399 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3400 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3401 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3402 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3403 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3404 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3405 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3406 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3407 power management software that may be active.
3408
3409 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3410 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3411 target event handler.
3412 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3413 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3414 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3415 sets up those clocks).
3416 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3417 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3418 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3419 in the target config file.
3420 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3421 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3422 config file instead.
3423 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3424 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3425 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3426
3427 @example
3428 jtag_rclk 3000
3429 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3430 @end example
3431
3432 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3433 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3434 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3435 may not be the fastest solution.
3436
3437 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3438 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3439 which support adaptive clocking.
3440
3441 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3442 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3443 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3444 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3445 than the speed specified.
3446
3447 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3448 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3449 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3450 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3451
3452 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3453 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3454 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3455 JTAG clocking after setup.
3456 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3457 If the interface device can not
3458 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3459 @end deffn
3460
3461 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3462 @cindex adaptive clocking
3463 @cindex RTCK
3464 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3465 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3466 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3467 @example
3468 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3469 jtag_rclk 3000
3470 @end example
3471 @end defun
3472
3473 @node Reset Configuration
3474 @chapter Reset Configuration
3475 @cindex Reset Configuration
3476
3477 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3478 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3479 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3480 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3481 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3482 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3483 Please see the various board files for examples.
3484
3485 @quotation Note
3486 To maintainers and integrators:
3487 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3488 Normally the board configuration file
3489 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3490 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3491
3492 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3493 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3494 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3495 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3496 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3497 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3498 @end quotation
3499
3500 @section Types of Reset
3501
3502 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3503 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3504 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3505
3506 @itemize @bullet
3507 @item
3508 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3509 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3510 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3511 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3512 @item
3513 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3514 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3515 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3516 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3517 @item
3518 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3519 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3520 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3521 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3522 @item
3523 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3524 several other types of reset.
3525 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3526 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3527 There may be individual module resets.
3528 @end itemize
3529
3530 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3531 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3532 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3533 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3534 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3535 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3536 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3537 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3538 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3539
3540 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3541 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3542
3543 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3544 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3545 common issues are:
3546
3547 @itemize @bullet
3548
3549 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3550 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3551 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3552 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3553 when either of those signals is not connected.
3554 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3555 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3556 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3557 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3558
3559 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3560 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3561 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3562 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3563
3564 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3565 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3566 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3567 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3568 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3569 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3570 hardware debouncing.
3571 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3572 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3573
3574 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3575 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3576 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3577 to use push/pull output drivers.
3578 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3579 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3580 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3581 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3582
3583 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3584 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3585 issues (not limited to errata).
3586 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3587 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3588 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3589 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3590 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3591 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3592 @end itemize
3593
3594 There can also be other issues.
3595 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3596 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3597 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3598 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3599 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3600 Agreement (NDA).
3601
3602 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3603 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3604 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3605
3606 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3607 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3608
3609 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3610
3611 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3612 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3613 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3614 allowing it to be deasserted.
3615 @end deffn
3616
3617 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3618 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3619 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3620 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3621 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3622 @end deffn
3623
3624 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3625 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3626 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3627 allowing it to be deasserted.
3628 @end deffn
3629
3630 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3631 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3632 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3633 @end deffn
3634
3635 @anchor{reset_config}
3636 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3637 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3638 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3639 configuration scripts.
3640
3641 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3642 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3643 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3644 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3645 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3646 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3647 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3648 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3649
3650 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3651 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3652 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3653 -- may be specified at a time.
3654 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3655 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3656 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3657 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3658 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3659
3660 @itemize
3661 @item
3662 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3663 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3664 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3665 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3666 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3667
3668 @quotation Tip
3669 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3670 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3671 @end quotation
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3675 signal implementations.
3676 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3677 indicating everything behaves normally.
3678 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3679 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3680 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3681 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3682 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3683 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3684 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3685
3686 @item
3687 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3688 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3689 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3690 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3691 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3692 while SRST is asserted.
3693 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3694 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3695
3696 @item
3697 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3698 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3699 is required to use this option.
3700 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3701 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3702 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3703 be asserted before any target connection.
3704 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3705 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3706 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3707 @end itemize
3708
3709 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3710 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3711 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3712 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3713 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3714
3715 @itemize
3716 @item
3717 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3718 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3719 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3720 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3721
3722 @item
3723 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3724 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3725 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3726 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3727 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3728 @end itemize
3729 @end deffn
3730
3731 @section Custom Reset Handling
3732 @cindex events
3733
3734 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3735 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3736 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3737 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3738 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3739 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3740
3741 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3742 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3743 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3744 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3745 want to reset everything at once.
3746
3747 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3748 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3749 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3750 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3751 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3752 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3753 needs special attention.
3754
3755 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3756 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3757 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3758 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3759 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3760 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3761 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3762 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3763 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3764
3765 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3766 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3767 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3768 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3769 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3770
3771 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3772 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3773 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3774 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3775 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3776 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3777 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3778 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3779 or potentially some other value.
3780
3781 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3782 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3783 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3784 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3785 (or their associated targets)
3786 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3787
3788 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3789 they return.
3790 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3791 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3792 @end deffn
3793
3794 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3795 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3796 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3797 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3798 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3799 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3800 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3801 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3802 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3803 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3804 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3805 @end deffn
3806
3807 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3808 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3809 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3810 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3811 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3812 @end deffn
3813
3814
3815 @node TAP Declaration
3816 @chapter TAP Declaration
3817 @cindex TAP declaration
3818 @cindex TAP configuration
3819
3820 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3821 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3822
3823 @itemize @bullet
3824 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3825 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3826 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3827 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3828 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3829 start running that code.
3830 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3831 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3832 and missing connections.
3833 @end itemize
3834
3835 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3836 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3837 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3838 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3839 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3840
3841 @section Scan Chains
3842 @cindex scan chain
3843
3844 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3845 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3846 They also need to be added to
3847 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3848 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3849 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3850 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3851 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3852 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3853 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3854 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3855
3856 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3857 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3858 command, presented in the next chapter.
3859 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3860 debugging targets.)
3861 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3862
3863 @verbatim
3864 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3865 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3866 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3867 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3868 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3869 @end verbatim
3870
3871 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3872 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3873 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3874 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3875 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3876 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3877 until they are told to do so.
3878
3879 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3880 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3881 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3882 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3883
3884 @example
3885 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3889 by a given chip.
3890 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3891 and so forth.
3892 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3893 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3894 both inside a single chip and between them.
3895 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3896
3897 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3898 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3899 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3900 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3901 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3902 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3903 includes commands something like this:
3904
3905 @example
3906 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3907 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3908 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3909 @end example
3910
3911 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3912 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3913 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3914
3915 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3916 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3917 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3918 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3919 @example
3920 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3921 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3922 @}
3923 @end example
3924 @end deffn
3925
3926 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3927 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3928 and their status.
3929 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3930 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3931 but systems with a JTAG router can
3932 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3933 @end deffn
3934
3935 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3936 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3937
3938 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3939 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3940
3941 @section TAP Names
3942 @cindex dotted name
3943
3944 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3945 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3946 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3947 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3948 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3949 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3950 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3951 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3952
3953 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3954 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3955 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3956
3957 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3958
3959 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3960 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3961 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3962 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3963
3964 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3965 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3966 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3967 overridable.
3968
3969 @cindex TAP naming convention
3970 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3971 and should follow this convention:
3972
3973 @itemize @bullet
3974 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3975 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3976 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3977 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3978 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3979 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3980 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3981 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3982 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3983 with a single TAP;
3984 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3985 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3986 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3987 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3988 @end itemize
3989
3990 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3994 @*The length in bits of the
3995 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3996 @end itemize
3997
3998 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3999
4000 @itemize @bullet
4001 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4002 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4003 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4004 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4005 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4006 (the TAP is linked in).
4007 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4008 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4009 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4010 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4011 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4012 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4013 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4014 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4015 values that were found but not included in the list.
4016
4017 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4018 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4019 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4020 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4021 hardware to find these values.
4022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4023 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4024 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4025 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4026 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4027 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4028 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4029 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4030 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4031 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4032 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4033 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4034 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4035 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4036 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4037 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4038 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4039 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4040 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4041 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4042 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4043 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4044 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4045 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4046 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4047 @end itemize
4048 @end deffn
4049
4050 @section Other TAP commands
4051
4052 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4053 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4054 @end deffn
4055
4056 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4057 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4058 At this writing this TAP attribute
4059 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4060 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4061 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4062 See the next section for information about the available events.
4063
4064 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4065 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4066 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4067 @end deffn
4068
4069 @section TAP Events
4070 @cindex events
4071 @cindex TAP events
4072
4073 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4074 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4075 The other applies to debugger targets,
4076 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4077
4078 The TAP events currently defined are:
4079
4080 @itemize @bullet
4081 @item @b{post-reset}
4082 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4083 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4084 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4085 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4086 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4087
4088 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4089 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4090 of any particular target.
4091 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4092 @item @b{setup}
4093 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4094 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4095 @item @b{tap-disable}
4096 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4097 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4098 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4099 @item @b{tap-enable}
4100 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4101 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4102 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4103 @end itemize
4104
4105 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4106 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4107 contents to be accurate), you might:
4108
4109 @example
4110 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4111 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4112 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4113 @}
4114 @end example
4115
4116
4117 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4118 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4119 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4120 @cindex jrc
4121
4122 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4123 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4124 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4125 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4126 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4127
4128 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4129 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4130 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4131 be visible.
4132 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4133 ignores, such as:
4134
4135 @itemize
4136 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4137 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4138 TAPs receive new instructions.
4139 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4140 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4141 @end itemize
4142
4143 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4144 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4145 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4146 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4147
4148 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4149 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4150
4151 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4152 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4153 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4154 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4155 should define TAP event handlers using
4156 code that looks something like this:
4157
4158 @example
4159 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4160 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4161 @}
4162 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4163 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4164 @}
4165 @end example
4166
4167 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4168
4169 @example
4170 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4171 @end example
4172
4173 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4174 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4175 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4176 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4177
4178 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4179 If necessary, disables the tap
4180 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4181 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4182 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4183 and "0" if it is disabled.
4184 @end deffn
4185
4186 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4187 If necessary, enables the tap
4188 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4189 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4190 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4191 and "0" if it is disabled.
4192 @end deffn
4193
4194 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4195 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4196 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4197 and "0" if it is disabled.
4198
4199 @quotation Note
4200 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4201 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4202 @end quotation
4203 @end deffn
4204
4205 @anchor{autoprobing}
4206 @section Autoprobing
4207 @cindex autoprobe
4208 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4209
4210 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4211 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4212 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4213 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4214
4215 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4216 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4217 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4218 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4219 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4220 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4221 right when they come out of reset).
4222
4223 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4224
4225 @example
4226 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4227 reset_config trst_and_srst
4228 jtag_rclk 8
4229 @end example
4230
4231 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4232 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4233
4234 @enumerate
4235 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4236 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4237 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4238 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4239 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4240 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4241 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4242 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4243 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4244 that is discovered.
4245 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4246 register, it will report it.
4247 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4248 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4249 @end enumerate
4250
4251 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4252 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4253 that's a bit more complex:
4254
4255 @example
4256 clock speed 8 kHz
4257 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4258 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4259 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4260 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4261 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4262 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4263 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4264 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4265 @end example
4266
4267 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4268 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4269 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4270 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4271 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4272 and so forth.
4273
4274 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4275 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4276 @cindex DAP declaration
4277
4278 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4279 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4280 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4281 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4282 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4283
4284 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4285
4286 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4287 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4288 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4289 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4290 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4291
4292 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4293
4294 @itemize @bullet
4295 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4296 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4297 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4298 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4299 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4300 @end itemize
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn Command {dap names}
4304 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4305 for TCL scripting.
4306 @end deffn
4307
4308 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4309 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4310 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @deffn Command {dap init}
4314 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4315 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4316 initialization, too.
4317 @end deffn
4318
4319 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4320
4321 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4322 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4323 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4324 @end deffn
4325
4326 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4327 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4331 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4332 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4333 or set a new value @var{value}.
4334 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4335 @end deffn
4336
4337 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4338 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4342 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4343 value @var{value}.
4344
4345 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4346 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4347 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4348
4349 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4350 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4351 @end deffn
4352
4353 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4354 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4355 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4356 @end deffn
4357
4358 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4359 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4360 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4361 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4362 @end deffn
4363
4364 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4365 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4366
4367 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4368 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4369 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4370 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4371 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4372 for details.
4373
4374 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4375 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4376 the pattern:
4377 @example
4378 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4379 @end example
4380
4381 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4382 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4383 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4384 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4385 @example
4386 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4387 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4388 @end example
4389
4390 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4391 @example
4392 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4393 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4394 @end example
4395
4396 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4397 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4398
4399 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4400 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4401 example with a proper dap name:
4402 @example
4403 xxx.dap apcsw default
4404 @end example
4405 @end deffn
4406
4407 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4408 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4409 Disabled by default
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412
4413 @node CPU Configuration
4414 @chapter CPU Configuration
4415 @cindex GDB target
4416
4417 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4418 You can also access these targets without GDB
4419 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4420 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4421 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4422 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4423
4424 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4425 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4426
4427 @section Target List
4428 @cindex target, current
4429 @cindex target, list
4430
4431 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4432 where each member has a name.
4433 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4434 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4435 (plural!) command.
4436 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4437 look like with more than one:
4438 @verbatim
4439 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4440 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4441 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4442 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4443 @end verbatim
4444
4445 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4446 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4447 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4448 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4449 space seen by that current target.
4450 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4451 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4452 are examples; and there are many more.
4453
4454 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4455
4456 @deffn Command {target current}
4457 Returns the name of the current target.
4458 @end deffn
4459
4460 @deffn Command {target names}
4461 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4462 @example
4463 foreach t [target names] @{
4464 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4465 @}
4466 @end example
4467 @end deffn
4468
4469 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4470 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4471
4472 @deffn Command targets [name]
4473 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4474 command names are singular.}
4475
4476 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4477 targets in a user friendly form.
4478
4479 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4480 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4481 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4482 @end deffn
4483
4484 @section Target CPU Types
4485 @cindex target type
4486 @cindex CPU type
4487
4488 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4489 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4490 when calling @command{target create}.
4491 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4492 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4493 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4494 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4495 what core-specific commands may be available
4496 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4497 and more.
4498
4499 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4500 since there's a command to list them.
4501
4502 @anchor{targettypes}
4503 @deffn Command {target types}
4504 Lists all supported target types.
4505 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4506
4507 @itemize @bullet
4508 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4509 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4510 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4511 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4512 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4513 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4514 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4515 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4516 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4517 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4518 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4519 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4520 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4521 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4522 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4523 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4524 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4525 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4526 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4527 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4528 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4529 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4530 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4531 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4532 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4533 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4534 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4535 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4536 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4537 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4538 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4539 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4540 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4541 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4542 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4543 @itemize @minus
4544 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4545 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4546 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4547 @end itemize
4548 And two debug interfaces cores:
4549 @itemize @minus
4550 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4551 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4552 @end itemize
4553 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4554 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4555 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4556 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4557 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4558 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4559 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4560 @end itemize
4561 @end deffn
4562
4563 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4564 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4565 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4566 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4567 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4568 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4569 reflect design generations;
4570 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4571 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4572
4573 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4574 @section Target Configuration
4575
4576 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4577 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4578 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4579 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4580 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4581
4582 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4583 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4584 optional parts.
4585 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4586 command, created as part of target creation.
4587
4588 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4589 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4590 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4591 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4592 to be much more board-specific.
4593 The key steps you use might look something like this
4594
4595 @example
4596 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4597 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4598 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4599 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4600 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4601 @end example
4602
4603 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4604 on-chip SRAM.
4605 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4606 writes to target memory;
4607 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4608 GDB memory checksumming;
4609 and more.
4610
4611 @quotation Warning
4612 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4613 inaccessible when application code
4614 (such as an operating system)
4615 enables or disables the MMU.
4616 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4617 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4618 easy access to other addresses needed.
4619 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4620 @end quotation
4621
4622 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4623 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4624 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4625 controllers.
4626 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4627 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4628 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4629
4630 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4631 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4632 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4633 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4634 purposes including additional configuration.
4635
4636 @itemize @bullet
4637 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4638 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4639 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4640 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4641
4642 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4643 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4644 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4645 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4646 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4647 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4648 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4649
4650 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4651 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4652 @end itemize
4653 @end deffn
4654
4655 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4656 The options accepted by this command may also be
4657 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4658 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4659 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4660
4661 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4662 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4663 and changing its endianness.
4664
4665 @itemize @bullet
4666
4667 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4668 used to access this target.
4669
4670 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4671 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4672 create and manage DAP instances.
4673
4674 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4675 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4676
4677 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4678 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4679 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4680 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4681 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4682 same event name assigns only one handler.
4683
4684 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4685 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4686
4687 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4688 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4689 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4690 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4691 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4692 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4693 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4694
4695 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4696 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4697 or virtual address is being used.
4698
4699 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4700 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4701
4702 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4703 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4704 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4705 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4706 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4707
4708 @anchor{rtostype}
4709 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4710 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4711 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4712 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4713 @option{RIOT}
4714 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4715
4716 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4717 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4718 access the target for debugging.
4719
4720 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4721 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4722 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4723 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4724
4725 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4726 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4727 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4728 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4729 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4730
4731 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4732 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4733 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4734 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4735 command @command{gdb_port}.
4736 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4737
4738 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4739 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4740 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4741 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4742 @end itemize
4743 @end deffn
4744
4745 @section Other $target_name Commands
4746 @cindex object command
4747
4748 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4749 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4750
4751 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4752 Once a button is created a button
4753 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4754 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4755 configure it like this:
4756
4757 @example
4758 # Create
4759 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4760 # Modify
4761 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4762 # Query
4763 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4764 # Report
4765 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4766 @end example
4767
4768 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4769 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4770
4771 @example
4772 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4773 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4774 @end example
4775
4776 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4777
4778 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4779 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4780 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4781 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4782 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4783 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4784 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4785 They are not otherwise documented here.
4786 @end deffn
4787
4788 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4789 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4790 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4791 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4792 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4793 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4794 the target side uses raw memory.
4795
4796 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4797 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4798 The script orientation comes from working with data
4799 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4800 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4801 and neither store nor return those values.
4802
4803 @itemize
4804 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4805 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4806 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4807 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4808 @end itemize
4809 @end deffn
4810
4811 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4812 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4813 @command{$target_name configure}
4814 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4815 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4816 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4817 There are a few special cases:
4818
4819 @itemize @bullet
4820 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4821 event named @var{event_name}.
4822 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4823 two parameters.
4824 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4825 This is a special case because this is set using
4826 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4827 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4828 @end itemize
4829
4830 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4831 all the targets you might use something like this:
4832
4833 @example
4834 foreach name [target names] @{
4835 set y [$name cget -endian]
4836 set z [$name cget -type]
4837 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4838 $x $name $y $z]
4839 @}
4840 @end example
4841 @end deffn
4842
4843 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4844 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4845 Displays the current target state:
4846 @code{debug-running},
4847 @code{halted},
4848 @code{reset},
4849 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4850 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4851 @end deffn
4852
4853 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4854 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4855 currently associated with this target.
4856 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4857 @end deffn
4858
4859 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4860 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4861 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4862 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4863 @end deffn
4864
4865 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4866 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4867 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4868 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4869 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4870 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4871 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4872 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4873 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4874 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4875 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4876 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4877 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4878 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4879 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4880 @end deffn
4881
4882 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4883 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4884 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4885 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4886 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4887 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4888 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4889 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4890 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4891 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4892 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4893 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4894 @end deffn
4895
4896 @anchor{targetevents}
4897 @section Target Events
4898 @cindex target events
4899 @cindex events
4900 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4901 For example:
4902 @itemize @bullet
4903 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4904 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4905 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4906 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4907 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4908 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4909 to set up system clocks or
4910 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4911 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4912 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4913 @end itemize
4914
4915 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4916 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4917 @command{target create ... -event}.
4918
4919 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4920 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4921 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4922
4923 @example
4924 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4925 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4926 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4927 @}
4928 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4929 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4930 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4931 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4932 @}
4933 @end example
4934
4935 The following target events are defined:
4936
4937 @itemize @bullet
4938 @item @b{debug-halted}
4939 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4940 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4941 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4942 @item @b{early-halted}
4943 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4944 @item @b{examine-start}
4945 @* Before target examine is called.
4946 @item @b{examine-end}
4947 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4948 @item @b{examine-fail}
4949 @* After target examine fails.
4950 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4951 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4952 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4953 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4954 connect GDB to running target.
4955 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4956 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4957 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4958 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4959 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4960 is in RAM or read only memory.
4961 Default is @code{halt}
4962 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4963 @* When GDB disconnects
4964 @item @b{gdb-end}
4965 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4966 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4967 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4968 @code{reset init})
4969 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4970 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4971 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4972 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4973 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4974 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4975 @item @b{gdb-start}
4976 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4977 @item @b{halted}
4978 @* The target has halted
4979 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4980 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4981 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4982 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4983 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4984 @item @b{reset-assert}
4985 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4986 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4987 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4988 it instead of asserting SRST.
4989 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4990 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4991 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4992 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4993 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4994 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4995 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4996 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4997 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4998 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4999 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5000 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5001 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5002 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5003 released on the scan chain.
5004 @item @b{reset-end}
5005 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5006 @item @b{reset-init}
5007 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5008 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5009
5010 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5011 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5012 multiplexing, and so on.
5013 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5014 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5015 @item @b{reset-start}
5016 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5017 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5018
5019 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5020 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5021 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5022 @item @b{resume-start}
5023 @* Before any target is resumed
5024 @item @b{resume-end}
5025 @* After all targets have resumed
5026 @item @b{resumed}
5027 @* Target has resumed
5028 @item @b{step-start}
5029 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5030 @item @b{step-end}
5031 @* After single-step has completed
5032 @item @b{trace-config}
5033 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5034 @end itemize
5035
5036 @node Flash Commands
5037 @chapter Flash Commands
5038
5039 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5040 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5041 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5042 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5043 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5044 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5045 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5046 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5047 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5048
5049 Flash Steps:
5050 @enumerate
5051 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5052 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5053 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5054 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5055 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5056 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5057 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5058 @item GDB Flashing
5059 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5060 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5061 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5062 @end enumerate
5063
5064 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5065 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5066 so that it can't boot.
5067 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5068 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5069
5070 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5071 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5072 @cindex flash configuration
5073
5074 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5075 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5076 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5077 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5078 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5079 see the driver-specific documentation.
5080
5081 @itemize @bullet
5082 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5083 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5084 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5085 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5086 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5087 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5088 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5089 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5090 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5091 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5092 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5093 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5094 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5095 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5096 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5097 commands to the flash controller.
5098 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5099 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5100 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5101 for more information.
5102 @end itemize
5103 @quotation Note
5104 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5105 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5106 @end quotation
5107 @end deffn
5108
5109 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5110 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5111 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5112 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5113 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5114 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5115 @end deffn
5116
5117 @deffn Command {flash list}
5118 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5119 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5120 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5121 @end deffn
5122
5123 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5124 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5125 depends on the flash type.
5126 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5127 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5128 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5129 but most don't bother.
5130 @end deffn
5131
5132 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5133
5134 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5135 begins.
5136
5137 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5138 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5139 until the programming session is finished.
5140
5141 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5142 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5143
5144 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5145
5146 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5147 @cindex flash erasing
5148 @cindex flash reading
5149 @cindex flash writing
5150 @cindex flash programming
5151 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5152
5153 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5154 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5155 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5156 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5157 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5158
5159 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5160 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5161 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5162 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5163 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5164
5165 @quotation Note
5166 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5167 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5168 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5169 back to a flash bank.
5170 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5171 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5172 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5173 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5174 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5175 @end quotation
5176
5177 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5178 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5179 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5180 disabled first.
5181 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5182 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5183 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5184
5185 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5186 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5187 up to and including @var{last}.
5188 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5189 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5190 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5191 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5192 @end deffn
5193
5194 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5195 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5196 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5197 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5198 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5199 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5200 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5201 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5202 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5203 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5204 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5205 before erase starts.
5206 @end deffn
5207
5208 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5209 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5210 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5211 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5212 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5213 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5214 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5215 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5216 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5217 before issuing this command.
5218 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5219 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5220 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5221 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5222 @end deffn
5223 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5224
5225 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5226 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5227 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5228 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5229 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5230 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5231 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5232 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5233 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5234 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5235 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5236 @end deffn
5237
5238 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5239 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5240 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5241 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5246 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5247 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5248 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5249 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5254 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5255 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5256 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5257 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5258 @end deffn
5259
5260 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5261 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5262 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5263 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5264 to the base address for each section in the image.
5265 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5266 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5267 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5268 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5269 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5270 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5271 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5272 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5273 each image section.
5274
5275 @quotation Warning
5276 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5277 data you want to preserve.
5278 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5279 sections might be erased with no notice.
5280 @itemize
5281 @item
5282 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5283 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5284 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5285 @item
5286 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5287 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5288 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5289 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5290 @end itemize
5291 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5292 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5293 @end quotation
5294
5295 @end deffn
5296
5297 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5298 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5299 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5300 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5301 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5302 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5303 ordinary memory reads.
5304 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5305 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5306 check for successful programming.
5307 @end deffn
5308
5309 @section Other Flash commands
5310 @cindex flash protection
5311
5312 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5313 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5314 and display that status.
5315 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5316 @end deffn
5317
5318 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5319 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5320 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5321
5322 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5323 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5324 and possibly stale information.
5325 @end deffn
5326
5327 @anchor{flashprotect}
5328 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5329 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5330 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5331 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5332 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5333 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5334 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5335 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5336 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5337 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5338 @end deffn
5339
5340 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5341 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5342 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5343 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346 @anchor{program}
5347 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5348 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5349 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5350 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5351 @end deffn
5352
5353 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5354 @section Flash Driver List
5355 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5356 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5357 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5358
5359 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5360 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5361 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5362
5363 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5364
5365 @itemize
5366 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5367 @end itemize
5368
5369 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5370 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5371 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5372 @example
5373 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5374 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5375 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5376 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5377 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5378 @end example
5379 @end deffn
5380
5381 @subsection External Flash
5382
5383 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5384 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5385 @cindex CFI
5386 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5387 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5388 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5389 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5390 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5391 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5392 configure a bus and its timings), or
5393 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5394 on the flash chip.
5395 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5396 speed up operation.
5397
5398 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5399
5400 @itemize
5401 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5402 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5403 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5404 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5405 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5406 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5407 @end itemize
5408
5409 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5410 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5411
5412 @example
5413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5415 @end example
5416
5417 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5418 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5419 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5420
5421 @example
5422 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5423 @end example
5424
5425 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5426 @end deffn
5427
5428 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5429 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5430 @cindex SPI
5431 @cindex jtagspi
5432 @cindex bscan_spi
5433 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5434 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5435 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5436 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5437 accessed through JTAG.
5438
5439 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5440 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5441 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5442 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5443 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5444 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5445
5446 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5447 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5448 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5449 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5450 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5451 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5452 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5453 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5454
5455 @itemize
5456 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5457 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5458 @var{USER1} instruction.
5459 @end itemize
5460
5461 @example
5462 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5463 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5464 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5465 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5466 @end example
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5470 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5471 @cindex xcf
5472 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5473 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5474 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5475 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5476 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5477
5478 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5479 command accepts additional parameters:
5480 @itemize
5481 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5482 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5483 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5484 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5485 in master mode.
5486 @end itemize
5487 @example
5488 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5489 @end example
5490 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5491 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5492 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5493 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5494 dedicated sector.
5495 @end deffn
5496
5497 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5498 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5499 button.
5500 @example
5501 xcf configure 0
5502 @end example
5503 @end deffn
5504
5505 Additional driver notes:
5506 @itemize
5507 @item Only single revision supported.
5508 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5509 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5510 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5511 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5512 @end itemize
5513 @end deffn
5514
5515 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5516 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5517 @cindex SPIFI
5518 @cindex lpcspifi
5519 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5520 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5521 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5522
5523 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5524 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5525 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5526 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5527 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5528
5529 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5530 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5531 are configured by the driver.
5532
5533 @example
5534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5535 @end example
5536
5537 @end deffn
5538
5539 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5540 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5541 @cindex SMI
5542 @cindex stmsmi
5543 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5544 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5545 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5546 SPI flash devices.
5547 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5548 flash devices can be connected.
5549
5550 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5551 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5552 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5553 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5554 the flash content.
5555
5556 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5557 to identify the memory bank.
5558 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5559 flash size, are detected automatically.
5560
5561 @example
5562 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5563 @end example
5564
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5568 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5569 @cindex QuadSPI
5570 @cindex OctoSPI
5571 @cindex stmqspi
5572 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5573 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5574 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5575 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5576 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5577 mode is not.
5578
5579 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5580 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5581 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5582 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5583
5584 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5585 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5586 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5587
5588 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5589 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5590 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5591 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5592 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5593 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5594
5595 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5596 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5597 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5598 should be avoided.
5599
5600 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5601 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5602 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5603 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5604 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5605 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5606
5607 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5608 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5609 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5610 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5611 persist across openocd invocations.
5612
5613 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5614 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5615 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5616 required (see 'set' command).
5617
5618 @example
5619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5620 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5621 @end example
5622
5623 There are three specific commands
5624 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5625 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5626 chip specific write protection engaged.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5630 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5631 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5632 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5633 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5634 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5635
5636 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5637 which don't support an id command.
5638
5639 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5640 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5644 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5645 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5646 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5647 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5648
5649 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5650 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5651 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5652 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5653
5654 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5655
5656 To check basic communication settings, issue
5657 @example
5658 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5659 @end example
5660 for single flash mode or
5661 @example
5662 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5663 @end example
5664 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5665
5666 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5667 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5668 need a dummy address, e.g.
5669 @example
5670 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5671 @end example
5672 should return the status register contents.
5673
5674 @end deffn
5675
5676 @end deffn
5677
5678 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5679 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5680 Microcontroller platform.
5681
5682 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5683 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5684
5685 @example
5686 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5687 @end example
5688
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5692 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5693 @cindex ath79
5694 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5695 chip selects.
5696 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5697 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5698 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5699 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5700 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5701 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5702
5703 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5704 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5705 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5706 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5707 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5708 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5709 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5710 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5711 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5712 with the default CS0.
5713 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5714 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5715 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5716
5717 @example
5718 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5719
5720 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5721 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5722 # banks.
5723 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5724 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5725 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5726 @end example
5727
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5731 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5732 @cindex fespi
5733
5734 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5735
5736 @example
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5738 @end example
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5742
5743 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5744 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5745 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5746 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5747 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5748 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5749
5750 @example
5751 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5752 @end example
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5756 @cindex ambiqmicro
5757 @cindex apollo
5758 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5759 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5760 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5761 with the target using SWD.
5762
5763 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5764 the device class of the MCU.
5765 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5766 to set up the flash banks.
5767 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5768 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5769
5770 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5771 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5772 and the second bank starts after the first.
5773
5774 @example
5775 # Flash bank 0
5776 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5777 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5779 $_TARGETNAME
5780 @end example
5781
5782 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5783 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5784 are available to the user.
5785
5786 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5787
5788 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5789 Erase entire bank.
5790 @end deffn
5791 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5792 Erase device pages.
5793 @end deffn
5794 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5795 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5796 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5797 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5798 the flash.
5799 @end deffn
5800 @end deffn
5801
5802 @anchor{at91samd}
5803 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5804 @cindex at91samd
5805 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5806 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5807
5808 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5809
5810 The devices have one flash bank:
5811
5812 @example
5813 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5814 @end example
5815
5816 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5817 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5818 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5819 processor to be halted.
5820 @end deffn
5821
5822 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5823 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5824 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5825 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5826 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5827 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5828
5829 @example
5830 at91samd set-security enable
5831 @end example
5832 @end deffn
5833
5834 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5835 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5836 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5837 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5838 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5839 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5840 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5841 in order to disable this feature.
5842
5843 @example
5844 at91samd eeprom
5845 at91samd eeprom 1024
5846 @end example
5847 @end deffn
5848
5849 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5850 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5851 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5852 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5853 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5854 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5855
5856 @example
5857 at91samd bootloader
5858 at91samd bootloader 16384
5859 @end example
5860 @end deffn
5861
5862 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5863 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5864 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5865 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5869 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5870 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5871 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5872 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5873 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5874 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5875 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5876
5877 @example
5878 # Read user row
5879 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5880 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5881 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5882 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5883 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5884 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5885 @end example
5886 @end deffn
5887
5888 @end deffn
5889
5890 @anchor{at91sam3}
5891 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5892 @cindex at91sam3
5893 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5894 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5895 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5896 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5897 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5898 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5899 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5900 chips are confirmed.}
5901
5902 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5903 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5904 the following fixed locations:
5905
5906 @example
5907 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5909 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5910 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5911 @end example
5912
5913 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5914 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5915 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5916
5917 @itemize
5918 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5919 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5920 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5921 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5922 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5923 @end itemize
5924
5925 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5926
5927 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5928 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5929 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5930 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5931 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5932 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5933 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5934
5935 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5936 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5937 @end deffn
5938
5939 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5940 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5941 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5942 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5943 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5944 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5945 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5946 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5950 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5951 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5952 @end deffn
5953 @end deffn
5954
5955 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5956 @cindex at91sam4
5957 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5958 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5959 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5963 @cindex at91sam4l
5964 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5965 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5966 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5967
5968 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5969 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5970 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5971 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5972 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5973 @end deffn
5974 @end deffn
5975
5976 @anchor{atsame5}
5977 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5978 @cindex atsame5
5979 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5980 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5981 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5982
5983 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5984 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5985 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5986
5987 @example
5988 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5989 @end example
5990
5991 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5992 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5993 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5994 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5995 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5996 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5997
5998 @example
5999 atsame5 bootloader
6000 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6001 @end example
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
6005 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6006 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6007 processor to be halted.
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6011 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6012 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6013 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6014 @end deffn
6015
6016 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
6017 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6018 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6019 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6020 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6021 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6022 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6023 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6024
6025 @example
6026 # Read
6027 >atsame5 userpage
6028 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6029 # Write
6030 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6031 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
6032 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
6033 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6034 @end example
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @end deffn
6038
6039 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6040 @cindex atsamv
6041 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6042 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6043 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6047 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6048 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6049 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6050 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6051
6052 @example
6053 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6054 @end example
6055
6056 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6057 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6058
6059 @itemize
6060 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6061 @item @var{banks}
6062 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6063 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6064 @item @var{pages_size}
6065 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6066 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6067 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6068 @end itemize
6069
6070 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6071 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6072 will be autoconfigured.
6073 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6074
6075 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6076 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6077 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6078 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6079 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6080
6081 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6082 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6083 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6084 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6085 are not truly general purpose).
6086 @quotation Note
6087 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6088 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6089 @end quotation
6090 @end deffn
6091 @end deffn
6092
6093 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6094 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6095 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6096 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6097 @end deffn
6098
6099 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6100 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6101 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6102 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6103
6104 @example
6105 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6106 @end example
6107
6108 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6109 each single sector one by one.
6110
6111 @example
6112 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6113 @end example
6114
6115 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6116 @end deffn
6117
6118 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6119 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6120 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6121 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6122 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6123 starts at address 0.
6124
6125 @example
6126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6127 @end example
6128 @end deffn
6129
6130 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6131 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6132 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6133 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6134 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6135 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6136 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6137 and programming the serial flash.
6138
6139 @example
6140 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6141 @end example
6142 @end deffn
6143
6144 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6145 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6146 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6147 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6148 autoconfigures itself.
6149 @example
6150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6151 @end example
6152 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6153 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6154 this via the following command:
6155 @example
6156 efm32 debuglock num
6157 @end example
6158 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6159 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6160 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6161 supported.}
6162 @end deffn
6163
6164 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6165 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6166 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6167 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6168 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6169 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6170
6171 @example
6172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6173 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6174 @end example
6175
6176 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6177 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6181 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6182 is an uncommon operation.}
6183 @end deffn
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6187 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6188 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6189 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6190 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6191 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6192 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6193
6194 @example
6195 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6196 @end example
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6200 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6201 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6202 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6203 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6204 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6205 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6206 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6207 characters) ignored.
6208
6209 @example
6210 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6211 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6212 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6213 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6214 @end example
6215 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6216 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6220 @cindex kinetis
6221 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6222 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6223 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6224 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6225 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6226 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6227
6228 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6229 @itemize
6230 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6231 @end itemize
6232
6233 @example
6234 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6235 @end example
6236
6237 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6238 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6239 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6240 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6241 @end deffn
6242
6243 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6244 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6245 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6246 set by 'flash protect' command.
6247 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6248 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6249 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6250 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6251 with the rest of a flash image.
6252 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6256 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6257 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6261 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6262 and examine-fail event.
6263 @end deffn
6264
6265 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6266 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6267 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6271 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6272 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6273 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6274 command completes.
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6278 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6279 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6280 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6281 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6282
6283 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6284 Program Partition command.
6285
6286 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6287 Reset the device after partition setting.
6288
6289 Show partition size:
6290 @example
6291 kinetis nvm_partition info
6292 @end example
6293
6294 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6295 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6296 @example
6297 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6298 @end example
6299
6300 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6301 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6302 @example
6303 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6304 @end example
6305 @end deffn
6306
6307 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6308 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6309 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6313 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6314 Command disables watchdog timer.
6315 @end deffn
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6319 @cindex kinetis_ke
6320 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6321 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6322 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6323 autoconfigures itself.
6324 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6325
6326 @example
6327 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6328 @end example
6329
6330 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6331 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6335 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6336 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6337 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6338 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6339 @end deffn
6340
6341 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6342 Command disables watchdog timer.
6343 @end deffn
6344 @end deffn
6345
6346 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6347 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6348 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6349 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6350 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6351
6352 @quotation Note
6353 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6354 driver:
6355 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6356 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6357 @end quotation
6358
6359 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6360 which must appear in the following order:
6361
6362 @itemize
6363 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6364 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6365 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6366 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6367 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6368 LPC43x[2357])
6369 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6370 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6371 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6372 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6373 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6374 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6375 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6376 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6377 at which the core is running
6378 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6379 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6380 @quotation Note
6381 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6382 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6383 However, if you do provide it,
6384 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6385 @end quotation
6386 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6387 ROM IAP entry point.
6388 @end itemize
6389
6390 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6391
6392 @example
6393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6394 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6395 @end example
6396
6397 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6398 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6399 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6400 @end deffn
6401 @end deffn
6402
6403 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6404 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6405 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6406 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6407 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6408 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6409
6410 @example
6411 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6412 @end example
6413 @end deffn
6414
6415 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6416 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6417 from NXP.
6418
6419 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6420 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6421 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6422 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6423 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6424 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6425 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6426 you start the PLL.
6427
6428 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6429
6430 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6431 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6432 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6433
6434 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6435 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6436 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6437 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6438 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6439 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6440 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6441
6442 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6443 @example
6444 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6445 @end example
6446
6447 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6448 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6449 @code{flash banks} command.
6450
6451 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6452 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6453 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6454 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6455 a known signature.
6456 Example:
6457 @example
6458 lpc2900 signature 0
6459 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6460 @end example
6461 @end deffn
6462
6463 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6464 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6465 saves it to a file in binary format.
6466 Example:
6467 @example
6468 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6469 @end example
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6473 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6474 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6475 command:
6476
6477 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6478 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6479 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6480 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6481
6482 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6483 Example:
6484 @example
6485 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6486 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6487 @end example
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6491 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6492 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6493 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6494 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6495 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6496 912 bytes.
6497 @quotation Attention
6498 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6499 @end quotation
6500 Example:
6501 @example
6502 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6503 @end example
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6507 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6508 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6509 after the next power cycle.
6510 @quotation Attention
6511 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6512 @end quotation
6513 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6514 Example:
6515 @example
6516 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6517 flash info 0
6518 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6519 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6520 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6521 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6522 @end example
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6526 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6527 effective after the next power cycle.
6528 @quotation Attention
6529 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6530 @end quotation
6531 Examples:
6532 @example
6533 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6534 @end example
6535 @end deffn
6536 @end deffn
6537
6538 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6539 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6540 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6541 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6542
6543 @example
6544 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6545 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6546 @end example
6547
6548 @itemize @bullet
6549 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6550 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6551 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6552 @end itemize
6553
6554 Example usage:
6555 @example
6556 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6557 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6558 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6559 @} else @{
6560 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6561 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6562 @}
6563 @end example
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6567 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6568 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6569 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6570 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6571 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6572
6573 @example
6574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6575 @end example
6576
6577 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6578 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6579 only the main program flash.
6580
6581 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6582 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6583 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6584 @end deffn
6585
6586 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6587 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6588 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6589 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6590
6591 To erase and program the BSL:
6592 @example
6593 msp432 bsl unlock
6594 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6595 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6596 msp432 bsl lock
6597 @end example
6598 @end deffn
6599 @end deffn
6600
6601 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6602 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6603 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6604 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6605 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6606 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6607 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6608 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6609 also have division into regions: main and info.
6610 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6611 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6612
6613 @example
6614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6615 @end example
6616
6617 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6618
6619 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6620 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6621 @end deffn
6622
6623 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6624 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6628 Erase all userflash including info region.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6632 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6633 @end deffn
6634
6635 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6636 Check sectors protect.
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6640 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6644 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6645 @end deffn
6646
6647 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6648 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6652 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6653 @end deffn
6654
6655 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6656 Show information about flash driver.
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @end deffn
6660
6661 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6662 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6663 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6664 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6665 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6666
6667 @example
6668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6669 @end example
6670
6671 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6672
6673 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6674 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6675 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6676 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6677 code.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6681 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @end deffn
6685
6686 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6687 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6688 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6689
6690 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6691 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6692 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6693 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6694
6695 @example
6696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6697 @end example
6698 @end deffn
6699
6700 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6701 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6702 and integrate flash memory.
6703
6704 @example
6705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6707 @end example
6708
6709 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6710 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6711 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6712 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6713 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6714 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6715 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6716 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6717 @end deffn
6718 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6719 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6720 This will remove any Code Protection.
6721 @end deffn
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6725 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6726 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6727 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6728 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6729
6730 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6731 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6732
6733 @example
6734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6735 @end example
6736
6737 psoc4-specific commands
6738 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6739 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6740
6741 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6742 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6743
6744 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6745 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6746 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6747
6748 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6749 @end deffn
6750
6751 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6752 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6753
6754 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6755 @end deffn
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6759 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6760 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6761 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6762 apart from the base address.
6763
6764 @example
6765 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6766 @end example
6767
6768 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6769 @quotation Attention
6770 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6771 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6772 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6773 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6774 @end quotation
6775
6776 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6777
6778 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6779 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6780 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6781 @end deffn
6782 @end deffn
6783
6784 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6785 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6786 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6787 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6788 apart from the base address.
6789
6790 @example
6791 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6792 @end example
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6796 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6797 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6798 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6799
6800 @example
6801 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6802 @end example
6803
6804 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6805
6806 @itemize
6807 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6808 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6809 @end itemize
6810
6811 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6812
6813 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6814 @quotation Attention
6815 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6816 after successful write.
6817 @end quotation
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6821 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6822 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6823 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6824
6825 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6826 @itemize @bullet
6827 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6828 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6829 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6830 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6831 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6832 row size: 512 bytes.
6833 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6834 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6835 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6836 operation will erase row automatically.
6837 @end itemize
6838
6839 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6840 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6841
6842 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6843
6844 @example
6845 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6846 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6847 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6848 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6849 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6850 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6851
6852 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6853 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6854 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6855 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6856 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6857 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6858 @end example
6859
6860 psoc6-specific commands
6861 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6862 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6863 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6864 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6865 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6866 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6870 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6871 by @command{flash banks}.
6872 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6873 @end deffn
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6877 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6878 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6879 and SWD interface.
6880 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6881 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6882
6883 @example
6884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6885 @end example
6886
6887 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6888
6889 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6890 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6891 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6895 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6896 @end deffn
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6900 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6901 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6902 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6903 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6904
6905 @example
6906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6907 @end example
6908
6909 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6910 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6911 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6912 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6913 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6914 disabled.
6915
6916 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6917 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6918 @quotation Warning
6919 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6920 applied to all of them.
6921 @end quotation
6922 @end deffn
6923 @end deffn
6924
6925 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6926 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6927 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6928 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6929 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6930
6931 @example
6932 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6933 @end example
6934
6935 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6936 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6937 the flash driver.
6938
6939 @example
6940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6941 @end example
6942
6943 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6944 as per the following example.
6945 @example
6946 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6947 @end example
6948
6949 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6950
6951 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6952 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6953 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6957 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6958 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6959 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6960 @end deffn
6961
6962 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6963 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6964 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6968 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6969 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6970 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6974 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6975 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6976 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6980 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6981 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6982 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6983 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6984 @end deffn
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6988 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6989 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6990 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6991 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6992
6993 @example
6994 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6995 @end example
6996
6997 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6998 as per the following example.
6999 @example
7000 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7001 @end example
7002
7003 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7004 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7005 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7009 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7010 the flash driver.
7011
7012 @example
7013 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7014 @end example
7015
7016 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7017
7018 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
7019 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7020 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7024 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7025 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7026 @end deffn
7027
7028 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7029 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7030 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7034 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7035 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7036 @end deffn
7037
7038 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7039 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7040 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7041 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7042 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7043 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7044 @end deffn
7045
7046 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7047 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7048 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7049 @end deffn
7050 @end deffn
7051
7052 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7053 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7054 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7055 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7056 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7057
7058 @example
7059 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7060 @end example
7061
7062 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7063 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7064 the flash driver.
7065
7066 @example
7067 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7068 @end example
7069
7070 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7071
7072 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7073 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7074 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7078 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7079 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7083 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7084 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7085 @end deffn
7086
7087 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7088 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7089 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7090 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7091 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7092
7093 Example usage:
7094 @example
7095 # read OPTSR_CUR
7096 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7097 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7098 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7099 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7100 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7101 @end example
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7105 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7106 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7107 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7108 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7109 will be touched).
7110
7111 Example usage:
7112 @example
7113 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7114 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7115 @end example
7116 @end deffn
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7120 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7121 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7122 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7123 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7124
7125 @example
7126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7127 @end example
7128
7129 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7130 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7131 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7132 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7133 second bank.
7134
7135 @example
7136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7137 @end example
7138
7139 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7140
7141 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7142 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7147 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7148 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7152 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7153 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7154 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7155 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7156 @end deffn
7157 @end deffn
7158
7159 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7160 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7161 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7162 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7163 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7164 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7165
7166 @example
7167 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7168 @end example
7169
7170 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7171 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7172 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7173 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7174
7175 @example
7176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7177 @end example
7178
7179 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7180
7181 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7182 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7187 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7188 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7192 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7193 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7197 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7198 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7199 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7200
7201 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7202 @example
7203 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7204 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7205 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7206 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7207 @end example
7208
7209 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7210 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7214 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7215 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7216 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7217 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7218
7219 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7220 @example
7221 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7222 @end example
7223
7224 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7225 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7226 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7230 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7232 @end deffn
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7236 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7237 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7238 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7239 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7240
7241 @example
7242 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7243 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7244 @end example
7245
7246 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7247 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7248 for the specified flash bank.
7249 @end deffn
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7253 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7254 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7255 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7256 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7257
7258 @example
7259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7260 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7261 @end example
7262
7263 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7264 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7265 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7266
7267 @itemize @bullet
7268 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7269 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7270 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7271 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7272 @end itemize
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7278 @cindex str9xpec
7279
7280 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7281 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7282 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7283 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7284
7285 Here is some background info to help
7286 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7287 the str9:
7288 @enumerate
7289 @item
7290 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7291 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7292 @item
7293 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7294 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7295 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7296 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7297 @end enumerate
7298
7299 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7300 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7301 configured for flash bank 0.
7302 @example
7303 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7304 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7305 adapter assert srst
7306 # turn off target polling
7307 poll off
7308 # disable str9 core
7309 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7310 # read option bytes
7311 str9xpec options_read 0
7312 # re-enable str9 core
7313 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7314 poll on
7315 reset halt
7316 @end example
7317 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7318 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7319 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7320 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7321
7322 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7323
7324 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7325 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7326 @end deffn
7327
7328 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7329 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7330 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7331 @end deffn
7332
7333 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7334 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7335 erase the device.
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7339 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7343 Configure str9 boot bank.
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7347 Configure str9 lvd source.
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7351 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7355 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7359 Read str9 option bytes.
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7363 Write str9 option bytes.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7367 unlock str9 device.
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7373 @cindex swm050
7374 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7375
7376 @example
7377 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7378 @end example
7379
7380 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7381
7382 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7383 Erases the entire flash bank.
7384 @end deffn
7385
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388
7389 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7390 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7391 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7392 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7393
7394 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7395
7396 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7397 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7401 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7402 @end deffn
7403
7404 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7405 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7406 the flash clock.
7407 @end deffn
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7411 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7412 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7413 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7414 correct bank config.
7415
7416 @example
7417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7418 @end example
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7422 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7423 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7424 @end deffn
7425
7426 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7427 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7428 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7429
7430 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7431
7432 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7433 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7434 @end deffn
7435
7436 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7437 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @section NAND Flash Commands
7443 @cindex NAND
7444
7445 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7446 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7447 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7448
7449 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7450 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7451 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7452 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7453 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7454 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7455
7456 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7457 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7458 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7459 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7460 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7461 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7462 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7463 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7464 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7465 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7466
7467 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7468 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7469 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7470 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7471 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7472 every 512 bytes of data.
7473
7474 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7475 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7476 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7477 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7478 ECC mode is used.
7479
7480 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7481 @enumerate
7482 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7483 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7484 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7485 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7486 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7487 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7488 to access that device.
7489 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7490 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7491 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7492 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7493 de-brick a board.
7494 @end enumerate
7495
7496 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7497 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7498 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7499 are only 32 bits wide.
7500 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7501 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7502 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7503 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7504
7505 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7506 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7507 @cindex NAND configuration
7508
7509 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7510 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7511 OpenOCD has initialized.
7512
7513 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7514 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7515 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7516 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7517 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7518 they were a single (larger) device.
7519 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7520 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7521
7522 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7523 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7524 configuration files, not interactively.
7525
7526 @itemize @bullet
7527 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7528 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7529 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7530 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7531 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7532 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7533 commands to the NAND controller.
7534 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7535 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7536 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7537 for more information.
7538 @end itemize
7539 @end deffn
7540
7541 @deffn Command {nand list}
7542 Prints a summary of each device declared
7543 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7544 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7545 @example
7546 > nand list
7547 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7548 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7549 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7550 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7551 >
7552 @end example
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7556 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7557 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7558 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7559 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7560 it with most other NAND commands.
7561 @end deffn
7562
7563 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7564
7565 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7566 @cindex NAND reading
7567 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7568 starting at the specified offset.
7569 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7570
7571 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7572 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7573
7574 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7575 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7576 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7577
7578 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7579 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7580 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7581 method which handled that error correction.
7582
7583 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7584 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7585 @itemize @bullet
7586 @item no oob_* parameter
7587 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7588 @item @code{oob_raw}
7589 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7590 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7591 spare areas associated with each data page.
7592 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7593 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7594 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7595 @item @code{oob_only}
7596 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7597 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7598 spare areas associated with each data page.
7599 @end itemize
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7603 @cindex NAND erasing
7604 @cindex NAND programming
7605 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7606 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7607 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7608 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7609 If those parameters are not specified,
7610 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7611 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7612
7613 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7614 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7615 block marker.
7616 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7617 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7621 @cindex NAND writing
7622 @cindex NAND programming
7623 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7624 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7625 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7626 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7627
7628 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7629 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7630
7631 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7632 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7633 past the end of the device.
7634 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7635 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7636 if that's being written.)
7637
7638 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7639 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7640 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7641
7642 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7643 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7644 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7645 @itemize @bullet
7646 @item no oob_* parameter
7647 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7648 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7649 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7650 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7651 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7652 @item @code{oob_only}
7653 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7654 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7655 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7656 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7657 @item @code{oob_raw}
7658 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7659 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7660 un-altered OOB.
7661 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7662 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7663 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7664 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7665 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7666 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7667 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7668 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7669 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7670 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7671 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7672 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7673 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7674 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7675 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7676 @end itemize
7677 @end deffn
7678
7679 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7680 @cindex NAND verification
7681 @cindex NAND programming
7682 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7683 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7684 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7685
7686 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7687 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7688
7689 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7690 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7691 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7692 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7693 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7694
7695 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7696 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7697 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7698
7699 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7700 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7701 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7702 be removed in a future release.
7703 @end deffn
7704
7705 @subsection Other NAND commands
7706 @cindex NAND other commands
7707
7708 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7709 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7710 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7711 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7712 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7713 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7714 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7715 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7716
7717 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7718 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7719 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7720 @end deffn
7721
7722 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7723 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7724 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7725 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7726 status for each block.
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7730 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7731 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7732
7733 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7734 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7735 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7736 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7737 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7738
7739 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7740 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7741 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7742 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7743 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7744 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7745 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7749 @subsection NAND Driver List
7750 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7751 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7752 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7753
7754 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7755 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7756 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7757 address of the ECC controller.
7758 @example
7759 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7760 @end example
7761 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7762 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7763 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7764 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7765 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7766 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7767 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7768 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7769 @end deffn
7770 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7771 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7772 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7773 @end deffn
7774
7775 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7776 properly configured for input or output.
7777 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7778 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7779 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7780 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7781 @end deffn
7782 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7783 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7784 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7785 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7786 @end deffn
7787 @end deffn
7788
7789 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7790 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7791 chips from Texas Instruments.
7792 It takes three extra parameters:
7793 address of the NAND chip;
7794 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7795 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7796 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7797 @example
7798 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7799 @end example
7800 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7801 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7802 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7803 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7804 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7808 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7809 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7810 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7811 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7812 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7813 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7817 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7818 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7819 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7820 @end deffn
7821 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7822
7823 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7824 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7825 should work for this chip as well.
7826 @end deffn
7827
7828 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7829 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7830 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7831 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7832 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7833 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7834 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7835 @example
7836 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7837 @end example
7838 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7839 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7840 without parameter query status.
7841 @end deffn
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7845 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7846 parameter: the address of the controller.
7847 @example
7848 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7849 @end example
7850 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7851 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7852 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7853 change any behavior.
7854 @end deffn
7855
7856 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7857 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7858 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7859 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7860 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7861 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7862 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7863 specialized commands.
7864 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7865 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7866 change any behavior.
7867 @end deffn
7868
7869 @node Flash Programming
7870 @chapter Flash Programming
7871
7872 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7873 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7874 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7875
7876 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7877 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7878
7879 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7880 @enumerate
7881 @item 'init' is executed.
7882 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7883 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7884 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7885 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7886 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7887 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7888 @end enumerate
7889
7890 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7891
7892 @example
7893 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7894 # are optional parameters
7895 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7896 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7897
7898 # binary files need the flash address passing
7899 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7900 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7901 @end example
7902
7903 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7904 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7905 @cindex PLD
7906 @cindex FPGA
7907
7908 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7909 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7910 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7911 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7912 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7913 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7914 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7915
7916 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7917
7918 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7919 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7920 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7921
7922 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7923 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7924
7925 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7926 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7927 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7928 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7929 behavior.
7930 @end deffn
7931
7932 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7933 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7937 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7938 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7939 @end deffn
7940
7941 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7942
7943 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7944 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7945 that particular type of PLD.
7946
7947 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7948 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7949 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7950
7951 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7952 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7953 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7954
7955 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7956 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7957 for FPGA @var{num}.
7958 @end deffn
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @node General Commands
7962 @chapter General Commands
7963 @cindex commands
7964
7965 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7966 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7967 commands are documented elsewhere.
7968
7969 Intent:
7970 @itemize @bullet
7971 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7972 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7973 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7974 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7975
7976 @item @b{From the human}
7977 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7978 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7979
7980 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7981 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7982 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7983
7984 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7985 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7986 port is 5555.
7987 @end itemize
7988
7989
7990 @section Server Commands
7991
7992 @deffn {Command} exit
7993 Exits the current telnet session.
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7997 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7998 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7999 Not every command provides helptext.
8000
8001 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8002 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8003 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8004 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8005 @end deffn
8006
8007 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8008 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8009 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8010 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8011 Useful in connection with script files
8012 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
8016 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8017 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8018 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8019
8020 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8021 @example
8022 # redefine shutdown
8023 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8024 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8025 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8026 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8027 original_shutdown
8028 @}
8029 @end example
8030 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8031 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8032 @end deffn
8033
8034 @anchor{debuglevel}
8035 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8036 @cindex message level
8037 Display debug level.
8038 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8039 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8040 Level 0 is error messages only;
8041 level 1 adds warnings;
8042 level 2 adds informational messages;
8043 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8044 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8045 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8046 the command line along with the location of that log
8047 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8048 @xref{Running}.
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8052 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8053 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8054 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8055 @example
8056 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8057 @end example
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8061 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8062 the default log output channel is stderr.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8066 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8070 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8071 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8072 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8073 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8077 @section Target State handling
8078 @cindex reset
8079 @cindex halt
8080 @cindex target initialization
8081
8082 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8083 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8084 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8085 a current target which is used to perform the
8086 various operations. The current target may be changed
8087 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8088 target which should become current.
8089
8090 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8091 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8092 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8093 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8094 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8095
8096 @emph{With no arguments}:
8097 list all available registers for the current target,
8098 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8099 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8100 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8101 are flagged as such.
8102
8103 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8104 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8105 bypassing any internal cache.
8106
8107 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8108 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8109 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8110 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8111 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8112 relevant module will flush such values.
8113
8114 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8115 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8116
8117 @example
8118 > reg
8119 ===== ARM registers
8120 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8121 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8122 (2) r2 (/32)
8123 ...
8124 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8125 >
8126 @end example
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8130 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8131 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8132 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8133 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8134 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8135 (and enter debug mode).
8136 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8137
8138 @quotation Warning
8139 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8140 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8141 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8142 power mode by gating the core clock;
8143 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8144
8145 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8146 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8147 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8148 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8149 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8150 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8151
8152 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8153 work with a JTAG debugger.
8154 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8155 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8156 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8157 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8158 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8159 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8160 @end quotation
8161
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 @deffn Command resume [address]
8165 Resume the target at its current code position,
8166 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8167 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command step [address]
8171 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8172 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8173 @end deffn
8174
8175 @anchor{resetcommand}
8176 @deffn Command reset
8177 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8178 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8179 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8180 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8181 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8182 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8183
8184 The optional parameter specifies what should
8185 happen after the reset.
8186 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8187 The other options will not work on all systems.
8188 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8189
8190 @itemize @minus
8191 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8192 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8193 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8194 @end itemize
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8198 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8199 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8200 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8201 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8202 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8203 state.
8204 @end deffn
8205
8206 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8207 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8208 Set values of reset signals.
8209 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8210 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8211 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8212 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8213
8214 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8215 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8216 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8217 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8218 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8219 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8220 the signal will not be modified.
8221
8222 @quotation Note
8223 TRST is specially handled.
8224 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8225 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8226 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8227 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8228 instead of the TRST signal.
8229 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8230 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8231 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8232 with handlers for that event.
8233 @end quotation
8234 @end deffn
8235
8236 @section I/O Utilities
8237
8238 These commands are available when
8239 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8240 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8241 notably the ZY1000.
8242 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8243
8244 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8245
8246 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8247 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8248 the text file @file{filename}.
8249 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8250 The last string is followed by a newline.
8251 @end deffn
8252
8253 @deffn Command cat filename
8254 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8255 @end deffn
8256
8257 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8258 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8259 into @file{dest_filename}.
8260 @end deffn
8261
8262 @deffn Command ip
8263 @emph{No description provided.}
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @deffn Command ls
8267 @emph{No description provided.}
8268 @end deffn
8269
8270 @deffn Command mac
8271 @emph{No description provided.}
8272 @end deffn
8273
8274 @deffn Command meminfo
8275 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8276 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8277 @end deffn
8278
8279 @deffn Command peek
8280 @emph{No description provided.}
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @deffn Command poke
8284 @emph{No description provided.}
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @deffn Command rm filename
8288 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8289 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8290 @end deffn
8291
8292 @deffn Command trunc filename
8293 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8294 @end deffn
8295
8296 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8297 @section Memory access commands
8298 @cindex memory access
8299
8300 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8301 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8302 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8303 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8304
8305 @enumerate
8306 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8307 to change the current target.
8308 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8309 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8310 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8311 @end enumerate
8312
8313 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8314 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8315 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8316 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8317 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8318 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8319 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8320 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8321 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8322 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8323 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8324 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8325 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8326 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8327 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8328 @end deffn
8329
8330 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8331 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8332 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8333 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8334 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8335 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8336 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8337 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8338 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8339 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8340 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8341 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @anchor{imageaccess}
8345 @section Image loading commands
8346 @cindex image loading
8347 @cindex image dumping
8348
8349 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8350 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8351 binary file named @var{filename}.
8352 @end deffn
8353
8354 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8355 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8356 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8357 @end deffn
8358
8359 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8360 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8361 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8362 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8363 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8364 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8365 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8366 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8367 separately.
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8371 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8372 The file format may optionally be specified
8373 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8374 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8375 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8376 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8377 @example
8378 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8379 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8380 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8381 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8382 $address $length
8383 @}
8384 @end example
8385 @end deffn
8386
8387 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8388 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8389 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8390 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8391 The file format may optionally be specified
8392 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8393 @end deffn
8394
8395 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8396 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8397 The file format may optionally be specified
8398 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8399 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8403 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8404 The file format may optionally be specified
8405 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8406 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409
8410 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8411 @cindex breakpoint
8412 @cindex watchpoint
8413
8414 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8415 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8416 watchpoints.
8417 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8418
8419 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8420 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8421 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8422 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8423 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8424 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8425
8426 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8427 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8431 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8432 @end deffn
8433
8434 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8435 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8436 @end deffn
8437
8438 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8439 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8440 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8441 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8442 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8443 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8444 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8445 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8446 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449
8450 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8451
8452 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8453 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8454 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8455 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8456 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8457 running, can be used.
8458 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8459 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8460 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8461
8462 @quotation Note
8463 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8464 @end quotation
8465
8466 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8467 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8468 communication, respectively.
8469
8470 @quotation Note
8471 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8472 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8473 example.
8474 @end quotation
8475
8476 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8477 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8478 of TCP/IP connections.
8479
8480 @deffn Command {rtt setup} address size ID
8481 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8482 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8483 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8484 @var{size} bytes.
8485 @end deffn
8486
8487 @deffn Command {rtt start}
8488 Start RTT.
8489 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8490 @end deffn
8491
8492 @deffn Command {rtt stop}
8493 Stop RTT.
8494 @end deffn
8495
8496 @deffn Command {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8497 Display the polling interval.
8498 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8499 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8500 checked for new data.
8501 @end deffn
8502
8503 @deffn Command {rtt channels}
8504 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8505 @end deffn
8506
8507 @deffn Command {rtt channellist}
8508 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8509 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8510 @end deffn
8511
8512 @deffn Command {rtt server start} port channel
8513 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8514 @end deffn
8515
8516 @deffn Command {rtt server stop} port
8517 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8518 @end deffn
8519
8520 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8521 on the target device.
8522
8523 @example
8524 resume
8525
8526 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8527 rtt start
8528
8529 rtt server start 9090 0
8530 @end example
8531
8532 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8533 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8534 TCP/IP port 9090.
8535
8536
8537 @section Misc Commands
8538
8539 @cindex profiling
8540 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8541 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8542 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8543 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8544 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8545 limit the address range.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn Command {version}
8549 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8550 @end deffn
8551
8552 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8553 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8554 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8558 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8559 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8560 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8561
8562 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8563 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8564 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8565 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8566
8567 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8568 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8569 @cindex tracing
8570 @cindex ETM
8571 @cindex ETB
8572
8573 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8574 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8575 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8576
8577 @itemize
8578 @item
8579 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8580 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8581 supports such an interface.
8582 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8583 and trace port support.)
8584 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8585 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8586 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8587 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8588 in the board-specific configuration file.
8589 @item
8590 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8591 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8592 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8593 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8594 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8595 @end itemize
8596
8597 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8598
8599 @quotation Issues
8600 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8601 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8602
8603 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8604 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8605 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8606 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8607 dummy trace port driver}.
8608
8609 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8610 as well as tracing only during specific states
8611 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8612
8613 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8614 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8615 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8616 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8617 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8618
8619 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8620 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8621 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8622 this original style of JTAG access.
8623 @end quotation
8624
8625 @subsection ETM Configuration
8626 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8627
8628 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8629 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8630 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8631
8632 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8633 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8634 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8635 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8636 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8637 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8638 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8639 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8640 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8641
8642 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8643 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8644 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8645
8646 @quotation Warning
8647 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8648 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8649 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8650 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8651 @end quotation
8652
8653 @quotation Note
8654 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8655 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8656 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8657 what CPU activities are traced.
8658 @end quotation
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn Command {etm info}
8662 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8663 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8664 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8665 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8666 @end deffn
8667
8668 @deffn Command {etm status}
8669 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8670 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8671 Did trace data overflow?
8672 Was it triggered?
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8676 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8677 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8678 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8679 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8680
8681 @itemize
8682 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8683 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8684 The value is one of
8685 @option{none} (save nothing),
8686 @option{data} (save data),
8687 @option{address} (save addresses),
8688 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8689 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8690 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8691 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8692 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8693 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8694 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8695 trace stream without an image of the code.
8696 @end itemize
8697 @end deffn
8698
8699 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8700 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8701 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8702 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8703 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8704
8705 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8706 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8707 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8711
8712 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8713 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8714 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8715
8716 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8717 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8718 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8719 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8720 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8721 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8722 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8723
8724 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8725
8726 @itemize
8727 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8728 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8729 for instruction access within that function's body.
8730 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8731 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8732 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8733 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8734 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8735 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8736 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8737 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8738 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8739 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8740 @item @emph{... more}
8741 @end itemize
8742
8743 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8744 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8745
8746 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8747 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8748 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8749 @end deffn
8750
8751 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8752 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8753 @end deffn
8754
8755 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8756 Opens an image file.
8757 @end deffn
8758
8759 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8760 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 @deffn Command {etm start}
8764 Starts trace data collection.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8768 Stops trace data collection.
8769 @end deffn
8770
8771 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8772 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8773
8774 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8775
8776 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8777 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8778 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8779 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8780 any trace data collection.}
8781 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8782 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8783 @end deffn
8784 @end deffn
8785
8786 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8787 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8788 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8789 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8790 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8791 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8792 @end deffn
8793 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8794 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8795 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8796 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8797 trace trigger becomes active.
8798
8799 @itemize
8800 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8801 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8802 afterwards.
8803 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8804 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8805 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8806 what caused that event to happen.
8807 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8808 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8809 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8810 how the event caused trouble.
8811 @end itemize
8812 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8813 @end deffn
8814
8815 @end deffn
8816
8817 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8818 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8819 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8820 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8821 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8822
8823 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8824 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8825
8826 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8827 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8828 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8832 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8836 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8837 @end deffn
8838 @end deffn
8839
8840 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8841 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8842 @cindex CTI
8843
8844 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8845 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8846 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8847 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8848 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8849 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8850
8851 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8852 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8853 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8854 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8855 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8856 including additional configuration.
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8860 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8864 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8865 @end deffn
8866
8867 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8868 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8869 @end deffn
8870
8871 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8872 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8873 @end deffn
8874
8875 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8876 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8877 @end deffn
8878
8879 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8880 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8881 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8882 @end deffn
8883
8884 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8885 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8886 of the CTI.
8887 @end deffn
8888
8889 @deffn Command {cti names}
8890 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8891 useful in TCL scripting.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @section Generic ARM
8895 @cindex ARM
8896
8897 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8898 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8899 commands that may be available.
8900
8901 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8902 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8903 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8904 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8905 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8906 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8910 @cindex disassemble
8911 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8912 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8913 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8914 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8915 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8916 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8917 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8918
8919 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8920 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8921 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8922 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8923 with a handful of exceptions.
8924 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8925 @end deffn
8926
8927 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8928 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8929 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8930 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8931 and using the MCR instruction.
8932 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8933 an ARM register.)
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8937 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8938 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8939 and the MRC instruction.
8940 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8941 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8942 an ARM register.)
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8946 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8947 core mode if necessary.
8948 @end deffn
8949
8950 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8951 @cindex ARM semihosting
8952 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8953
8954 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8955 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8956 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8957 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8958 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8959 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8963 @cindex ARM semihosting
8964 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8965
8966 @example
8967 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8968 @end example
8969
8970 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8971 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8972 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8973 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8977 @cindex ARM semihosting
8978 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8979 status.
8980
8981 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8982 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8983 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8984 debugger.
8985 @end deffn
8986
8987 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8988 @cindex ARM semihosting
8989 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8990
8991 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8992 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8993 the value returned by the target.
8994
8995 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8996 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8997 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8998 encountering a break.
8999
9000 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9001 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9002 to the debugger.
9003 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9004 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9005 request or equivalent").
9006
9007 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9008 this option (default: disabled).
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9012 @cindex ARMv4
9013 @cindex ARMv5
9014
9015 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9016 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9017 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9018 variant.
9019
9020 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9021 @cindex ARM7
9022 @cindex ARM9
9023
9024 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9025 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9026 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9027 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9028
9029 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9030 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9031 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9032 instead of breakpoints.
9033 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9034
9035 This should be
9036 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9037 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9038 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9042 @cindex DCC
9043 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9044 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9045 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9046
9047 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9048 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9049 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9053 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9054 that don't check completion of the operation.
9055 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9056
9057 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9058 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9059 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9060 @end deffn
9061
9062 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
9063 @cindex ARM720T
9064
9065 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
9066 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9067 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
9068 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
9069
9070 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
9071 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9072 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9073
9074 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
9075 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9076 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9080 @cindex ARM9
9081
9082 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9083 integer processors.
9084 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9085
9086 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9087 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9088 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9089 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9090
9091 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9092 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9093 @cindex vector_catch
9094 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9095 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9096 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9097 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9098 to those hardware vectors.
9099
9100 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9101 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9102 vector catch hardware to intercept
9103 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9104 @option{none} of them,
9105 or a list with one or more of the following:
9106 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9107 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9111 @cindex ARM920T
9112
9113 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9114 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9115 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9116 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9117 and ARM9 commands.
9118
9119 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9120 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9121 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9122 @end deffn
9123
9124 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9125 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9126 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9127 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9128 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9129 (Not all registers can be written.)
9130 @end deffn
9131
9132 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
9133 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9134 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9135
9136 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
9137 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
9138 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
9139 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
9140 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
9141 or using zero if no other address is provided.
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9145 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9146 @end deffn
9147
9148 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9149 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9150 @end deffn
9151
9152 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9153 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9154
9155 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9156 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9157 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9158 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9159 and ARM9 commands.
9160
9161 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9162 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9163
9164 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9165 Print information about the caches found.
9166 @end deffn
9167
9168 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9169 @cindex ARM966E
9170
9171 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9172 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9173 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9174 and ARM9 commands.
9175
9176 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9177 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9178 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9179 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9180 ARM966E-S TRM.
9181 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9182 as required for BIST support.
9183 @end deffn
9184
9185 @subsection XScale specific commands
9186 @cindex XScale
9187
9188 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9189
9190 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9191 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9192 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9193 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9194 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9195 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9196 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9197
9198 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9199 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9200 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9201 the mini-IC.
9202
9203 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9204 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9205 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9206 code layout in memory:
9207 @example
9208 _vectors:
9209 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9210 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9211 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9212 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9213 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9214 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9215 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9216 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9217 .org 0x100
9218 .long real_reset_vector
9219 .long real_ui_handler
9220 .long real_swi_handler
9221 .long real_pf_abort
9222 .long real_data_abort
9223 .long 0 /* unused */
9224 .long real_irq_handler
9225 .long real_fiq_handler
9226 @end example
9227
9228 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9229 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9230 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9231 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9232 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9233 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9234 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9235 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9236 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9237 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9238 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9239 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9240 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9241 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9242 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9243 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9244 software.
9245
9246 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9247 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9248 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9249 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9250
9251 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9252 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9253 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9254 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9255 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9256 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9257 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9258 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9259 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9260
9261 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9262 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9263
9264 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9265 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9266 @end deffn
9267
9268 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9269 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9270 @end deffn
9271
9272 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9273 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9274 @end deffn
9275
9276 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9277 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9278 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9282 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9286 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9290 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9294 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9298 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9302 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9303 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9304 and modifying how it is emptied.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9308 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9309 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9310 The image @var{type} may be one of
9311 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9312 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9313 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9314 @end deffn
9315
9316 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9317 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9318 @cindex vector_catch
9319 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9320 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9321
9322 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9323 @example
9324 0x01 Trap Reset
9325 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9326 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9327 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9328 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9329 0x20 reserved
9330 0x40 Trap IRQ
9331 0x80 Trap FIQ
9332 @end example
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9336 @cindex vector_table
9337
9338 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9339 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9340 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9341 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9342 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9343
9344 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9345
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9349 @cindex ARMv6
9350
9351 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9352 @cindex ARM11
9353
9354 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9355 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9356 which is enabled by default.
9357 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9358 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9359 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9360 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9361 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9362 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9366 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9367 which is enabled by default.
9368 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9369 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9370 @end deffn
9371
9372 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9373 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9374 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9375 they are disabled by default.
9376 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9380 @cindex vector_catch
9381 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9382 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9383 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9384
9385 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9386 for certain hardware events.
9387 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9388 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9389 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9393 @cindex ARMv7
9394 @cindex ARMv8
9395
9396 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9397 @cindex Cortex-A
9398
9399 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9400 display information about target caches
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9404 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9405 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9406 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9407 Defaults to 'off'.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9411 Initialize core debug
9412 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9416 Display/set the current SMP mode
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9420 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9424 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9428 configure l2x cache
9429 @end deffn
9430
9431 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9432 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9433 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9434 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9435 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9439 @cindex Cortex-R
9440
9441 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9442 Initialize core debug
9443 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9444 @end deffn
9445
9446 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9447 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9448 @end deffn
9449
9450
9451 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9452 @cindex tracing
9453 @cindex SWO
9454 @cindex SWV
9455 @cindex TPIU
9456 @cindex ITM
9457 @cindex ETM
9458
9459 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)}) @
9460 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9461 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9462
9463 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9464 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9465 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9466 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9467
9468 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9469 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9470 debugger adapter features.
9471
9472 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9473 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9474
9475 Command options:
9476 @itemize @minus
9477 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9478 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9479 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware).
9480 @item @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9481 gather trace data then:
9482
9483 @itemize @minus
9484 @item append it to a regular file or a named pipe if @var{filename} is specified.
9485 @item listen to a TCP/IP port if @var{:port} is specified, then broadcast the trace data over this port.
9486 @item if '-' is specified, OpenOCD will forward trace data to @command{tcl_trace} command.
9487 @*@b{Note:} while broadcasting to file or TCP, the forwarding to @command{tcl_trace} will remain active.
9488 @end itemize
9489
9490 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9491 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width}.
9492 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9493 coding.
9494 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9495 regular UART 8N1) coding.
9496 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9497 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9498 data is to be output via SWO.
9499 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9500 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK).
9501 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9502 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9503 rate automatically.
9504 @end itemize
9505
9506 Example usage:
9507 @enumerate
9508 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9509 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9510 enough to:
9511 @example
9512 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9513 ...
9514 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9515 ...
9516 @end example
9517 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9518 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9519 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9520 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9521 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9522 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9523 @example
9524 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9525 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9526 @end example
9527 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9528 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9529 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9530 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9531 @example
9532 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9533 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9534 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9535 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9536 @end example
9537 @end enumerate
9538 @end deffn
9539
9540 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9541 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9542 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9546 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9550 @cindex Cortex-M
9551
9552 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9553 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9554
9555 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9556 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9557 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9558 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9559 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9560 the step command leaves with the core running.
9561
9562 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9563 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9564 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9565 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9566
9567 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9568 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9569 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9570 does.
9571
9572 Default is @option{auto}.
9573 @end deffn
9574
9575 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9576 @cindex vector_catch
9577 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9578 for certain hardware events.
9579
9580 Parameters request interception of
9581 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9582 @option{none} of them,
9583 or one or more of the following:
9584 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9585 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9586 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9587 @option{irq_err},
9588 @option{state_err},
9589 @option{chk_err}, or
9590 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9591 @option{reset}.
9592 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9593 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9594 are mapped to HardFault.
9595 UsageFault checks for
9596 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9597 must also be explicitly enabled.
9598
9599 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9603 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9604 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9605
9606 @itemize @minus
9607 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9608 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9609 @end itemize
9610
9611 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9612 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9613 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9614 to manually reset the peripherals.
9615 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9616
9617 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9618 instead.
9619 @end deffn
9620
9621 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9622 @cindex ARMv8-A
9623 @cindex aarch64
9624
9625 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9626 Display information about target caches
9627 @end deffn
9628
9629 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9630 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9631 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9632 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9633 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9634 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9635 @end deffn
9636
9637 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9638 @cindex disassemble
9639 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9640 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9641 @end deffn
9642
9643 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9644 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9645 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9646 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9647 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9648 @end deffn
9649
9650 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9651 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9652 @option{on}.
9653 @end deffn
9654
9655 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9656 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9657 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9658 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9659 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9660 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9661 @end deffn
9662
9663 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9664
9665 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9666 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9667
9668 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9669
9670 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9671 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9672 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9673 @end deffn
9674
9675 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9676 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9677 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9678 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9679 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9680 @end deffn
9681
9682 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9683
9684 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9685 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9686 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9687 @end deffn
9688
9689 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9690
9691 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9692 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9693 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9694 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9695 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9696 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9697 can be collected.
9698
9699 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9700 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9701 tooling.
9702
9703 @quotation Issues
9704 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9705 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9706 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9707 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9708
9709 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9710 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9711 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9712 software operation on the CPU.
9713 @end quotation
9714
9715 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9716 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9717 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9718 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9719 @end deffn
9720
9721 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9722 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9726 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9727 control is disabled.
9728 @end deffn
9729
9730 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9731 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9732 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9733 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9734
9735 Supported trace formats:
9736 @itemize
9737 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9738 timing to be determined.
9739 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9740 addresses.
9741 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9742 @end itemize
9743 @end deffn
9744
9745 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9746 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9747 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9748 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9749
9750 Supported conditions:
9751 @itemize
9752 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9753 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9754 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9755 instruction matches start data and mask.
9756 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9757 instruction matches start data and mask.
9758 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9759 data and mask.
9760 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9761 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9762 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9763 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9764 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9765 @end itemize
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9769 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9770 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9771 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9772
9773 Supported conditions:
9774 @itemize
9775 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9776 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9777 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9778 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9779 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9780 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9781 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9782 data and mask.
9783 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9784 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9785 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9786 @end itemize
9787 @end deffn
9788
9789 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9790 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9791
9792 Supported triggers:
9793 @itemize
9794 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9795 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9796 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9797 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9798 collection.
9799 @end itemize
9800 @end deffn
9801
9802 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9803
9804 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9805 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9806 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9807 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9808 @end deffn
9809
9810 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9811 Display trace configuration.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9815 Display trace collection status.
9816 @end deffn
9817
9818 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9819 Start manual trace collection.
9820 @end deffn
9821
9822 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9823 Stop manual trace collection.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9827 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9828 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9829 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9830 @option{size} options using DMA.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9834 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9835 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9836 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9837 @option{size} options using DMA.
9838 @end deffn
9839
9840 @section Intel Architecture
9841
9842 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9843 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9844 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9845 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9846 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9847 @itemize
9848 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9849 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9850 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9851 @end itemize
9852
9853 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9854 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9855 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9856
9857 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9858 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9862 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9866 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9867 @end deffn
9868
9869 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9870 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9871 @end deffn
9872
9873 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9874 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9878 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9879 @end deffn
9880
9881 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9882
9883 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9884 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9885
9886 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9887 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9888 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9889 @end deffn
9890 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9891 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9892
9893 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9894
9895 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9896 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9897 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9898 @end deffn
9899
9900 @subsection Registers commands
9901 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9902 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9903 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9904
9905 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9906
9907 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9908 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9909 and "timer" groups.
9910
9911 @emph{example:}
9912 @example
9913 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9914 @end example
9915
9916
9917 @end deffn
9918 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9919 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9920
9921 @emph{group} can be "system",
9922 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9923 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @section RISC-V Architecture
9927
9928 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9929 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9930 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9931 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9932 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9933 implement version 0.11.
9934
9935 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9936
9937 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9938 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9939 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9940
9941 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9942
9943 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9944 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9945 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9946
9947 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9948 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9949 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9950 CSRs.
9951 @end deffn
9952
9953 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9954 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9955 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9956 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9957 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9958 This command must be executed before `init`.
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9962 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9963 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9964 @end deffn
9965
9966 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9967 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9968 deasserted.
9969 @end deffn
9970
9971 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9972 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9973 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9974 @end deffn
9975
9976 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9977 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9978 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9979 @end deffn
9980
9981 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
9982 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
9983 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
9984 on physical memory.
9985 @end deffn
9986
9987 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
9988 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
9989 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
9990 performed on physical memory.
9991 @end deffn
9992
9993 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
9994 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
9995 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
9996 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
9997 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
9998 race condition problem in your code.
9999
10000 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10001 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10005 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10006 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10007 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10008 values.
10009
10010 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10011 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10012 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10016 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10017 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10021 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10022 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10023 @end deffn
10024
10025 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10026 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10027 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10028 @end deffn
10029
10030 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10031 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10032 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10033 @end deffn
10034
10035 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10036
10037 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10038 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10039 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10040 @example
10041 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10042 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10043 @end example
10044
10045 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
10046 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
10050 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10054
10055 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10056 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10057
10058 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
10059 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10060 @end deffn
10061
10062 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
10063 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @section ARC Architecture
10067 @cindex ARC
10068
10069 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10070 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10071 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10072 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
10073 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10074 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10075 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10076 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10077 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10078 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10079 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10080 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10081 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10082 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10083 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10084
10085
10086 @subsection General ARC commands
10087
10088 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10089
10090 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10091 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10092 arguments:
10093
10094 @itemize @bullet
10095
10096 @item @code{-name} name
10097 @*Name of a register.
10098
10099 @item @code{-num} number
10100 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10101
10102 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10103 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10104
10105 @end itemize
10106
10107 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10108
10109 @itemize @bullet
10110
10111 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10112 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10113 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10114 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10115 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10116 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10117
10118 @item @code{-core}
10119 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10120 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10121 spaces.
10122
10123 @item @code{-bcr}
10124 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10125 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10126 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10127 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10128 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10129
10130 @item @code{-type} type_name
10131 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10132 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10133
10134 @item @code{-g}
10135 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10136 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10137 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10138 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10139 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10140
10141 @end itemize
10142
10143 @end deffn
10144
10145 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10146 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10147 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10148 @end deffn
10149
10150 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10151 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10152 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10153 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10154 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10155 startbit endbit}.
10156 @end deffn
10157
10158 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10159 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10160 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10161 @end deffn
10162
10163 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10164 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10165 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10169
10170 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10171 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10172 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10173 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10174
10175 @end deffn
10176
10177 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10178 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10179 registers.
10180 @end deffn
10181
10182 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10183 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10184 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10185 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10186
10187 @end deffn
10188
10189 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10190 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10191 registers.
10192 @end deffn
10193
10194 @section STM8 Architecture
10195 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10196 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10197
10198 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10199 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10200
10201 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10202 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10203 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10204 @cindex tracing
10205 @cindex libdcc
10206 @cindex DCC
10207 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10208 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10209 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10210 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10211
10212 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10213 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10214 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10215 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10216 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10217 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10218
10219 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10220 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10221 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10222 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10223 The target being debugged may
10224 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10225 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10226 each supported by a command:
10227
10228 @itemize
10229 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10230 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10231 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10232 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10233
10234 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10235 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10236 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10237
10238 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10239 and then displayed at any time.
10240 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10241
10242 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10243 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10244 @end itemize
10245
10246 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10247 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10248 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10249 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10250 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10251 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10252 does the same thing.
10253
10254 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10255 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10256 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10257 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10258 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10259
10260 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10261 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10262 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10263 @end deffn
10264
10265 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10266 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10267 in the order they triggered.
10268 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10269 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10270 history records.
10271 @end deffn
10272
10273 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10274 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10275 they have been triggered.
10276 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10277 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10278 and associates it with that identifier.
10279
10280 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10281 are not related except by this command.
10282 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10283 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10284 @end deffn
10285
10286
10287 @node JTAG Commands
10288 @chapter JTAG Commands
10289 @cindex JTAG Commands
10290 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10291 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10292 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10293 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10294 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10295
10296 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10297 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10298
10299 @itemize @bullet
10300 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10301 devices such as a CPUs.
10302 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10303 standard state machine (in parallel)
10304 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10305 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10306 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10307 while the reading previous ones.
10308 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10309 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10310 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10311 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10312 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10313 registers.
10314 @end itemize
10315
10316 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10317
10318 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10319 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10320 the order of TAP state transitions.
10321 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10322 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10323 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10324 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10325 these commands are not available.
10326
10327 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10328 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10329 that specify the entire register.
10330 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10331 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10332 The return value holds the original value of each
10333 of those fields.
10334
10335 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10336 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10337 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10338 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10339 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10340
10341 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10342 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10343
10344 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10345 in that state.
10346 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10347 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10348 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10349
10350 @quotation Warning
10351 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10352 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10353 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10354 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10355 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10356 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10357 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10358 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10359 @end quotation
10360 @end deffn
10361
10362 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10363 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10364 This may be used for performance tuning.
10365
10366 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10367 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10368 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10369 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10370 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10371 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10372 @end deffn
10373
10374 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10375 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10376 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10377 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10378 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10379 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10380
10381 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10382 in that state.
10383 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10384 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10385 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10386
10387 @quotation Note
10388 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10389 register values, unlike data register values.
10390 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10391 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10392 @end quotation
10393 @end deffn
10394
10395 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10396 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10397 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10398 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10399 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10400 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10401 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10402 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10403 The final state must also be stable.
10404 @end deffn
10405
10406 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10407 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10408 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10409 Instructions often need some time
10410 to execute before they take effect.
10411 @end deffn
10412
10413 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10414 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10415
10416 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10417 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10418 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10419 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10420 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10421 @end deffn
10422
10423 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10424 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10425 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10426 must also be enabled.
10427 Default is enabled.
10428 @end deffn
10429
10430 @section TAP state names
10431 @cindex TAP state names
10432
10433 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10434 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10435 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10436 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10437
10438 @itemize @bullet
10439 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10440 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10441 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10442 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10443 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10444 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10445 through the data register
10446 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10447 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10448 for update or more shifting
10449 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10450 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10451 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10452 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10453 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10454 through the instruction register
10455 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10456 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10457 for update or more shifting
10458 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10459 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10460 @end itemize
10461
10462 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10463 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10464 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10465 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10466
10467 @itemize @bullet
10468 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10469 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10470 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10471 may not be as expected.
10472 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10473 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10474 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10475 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10476 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10477 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10478 @end itemize
10479
10480 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10481 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10482
10483 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10484 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10485 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10486 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10487
10488 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10489 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10490 @cindex SVF
10491
10492 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10493 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10494 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10495 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10496
10497 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10498 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10499 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10500 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10501
10502 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10503 affect their semantics.
10504
10505 Command options:
10506 @itemize @minus
10507 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10508 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10509 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10510 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10511 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10512 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10513 on the real interface;
10514 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10515 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10516 errors.
10517 @end itemize
10518 @end deffn
10519
10520 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10521 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10522 @cindex XSVF
10523
10524 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10525 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10526 Xilinx devices.
10527 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10528 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10529
10530 @quotation Important
10531 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10532 @end quotation
10533
10534 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10535 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10536 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10537 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10538 that TAP.
10539 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10540 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10541 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10542 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10543 @end deffn
10544
10545 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10546 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10547 after building the software.
10548 You may find them useful:
10549
10550 @itemize
10551 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10552 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10553 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10554 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10555 @end itemize
10556
10557 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10558 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10559 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10560 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10561 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10562 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10563 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10564
10565
10566 @node Utility Commands
10567 @chapter Utility Commands
10568 @cindex Utility Commands
10569
10570 @section RAM testing
10571 @cindex RAM testing
10572
10573 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10574 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10575 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10576 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10577 hardware problems.
10578
10579 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10580 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10581 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10582 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10583
10584 Load the memory testing functions with
10585
10586 @example
10587 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10588 @end example
10589
10590 to get access to the following facilities:
10591
10592 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10593 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10594 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10595 @end deffn
10596
10597 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10598 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10599 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10600 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10604 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10605 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10606 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10607 @end deffn
10608
10609 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10610 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10611 @end deffn
10612
10613 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10614 @cindex Firmware recovery
10615
10616 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10617 devices recovery with JTAG.
10618
10619 For quickstart instructions run:
10620 @example
10621 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10622 @end example
10623
10624 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10625 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10626 @cindex GDB
10627 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10628 to debug remote targets.
10629 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10630
10631 @itemize
10632 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10633 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10634 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10635 as shown in this chapter.
10636 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10637 that also will probably need to be configured.
10638 @end itemize
10639
10640 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10641 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10642 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10643 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10644 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10645 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10646
10647 @section Connecting to GDB
10648 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10649 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10650 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10651 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10652 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10653
10654 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10655
10656 @enumerate
10657 @item
10658 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10659 @example
10660 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10661 @end example
10662 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10663
10664 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10665 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10666 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10667
10668 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10669 remote command above that becomes:
10670 @example
10671 tar ext :3333
10672 @end example
10673
10674 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10675 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10676 available through the command:
10677 @example
10678 target remote localhost:3333
10679 @end example
10680
10681 @item
10682 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10683 @example
10684 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10685 @end example
10686 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10687 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10688 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10689 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10690 @end enumerate
10691
10692 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10693 GDB command line.
10694
10695 @section Sample GDB session startup
10696
10697 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10698 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10699 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10700 small ARM program.
10701 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10702 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10703
10704 @example
10705 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10706 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10707 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10708 ...
10709 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10710 ...
10711 (gdb) load
10712 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10713 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10714 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10715 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10716 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10717 (gdb) continue
10718 Continuing.
10719 ...
10720 @end example
10721
10722 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10723 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10724 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10725 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10726
10727 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10728
10729 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10730 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10731 packet size and the device's memory map.
10732 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10733 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10734 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10735
10736 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10737 You may need to set those up by hand.
10738 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10739 something like:
10740
10741 @example
10742 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10743 @end example
10744
10745 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10746
10747 @example
10748 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10749 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10750 @end example
10751
10752 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10753 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10754 do not have such restrictions.
10755
10756 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10757 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10758 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10759 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10760
10761 @section Programming using GDB
10762 @cindex Programming using GDB
10763 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10764
10765 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10766 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10767 @example
10768 gdb_memory_map disable
10769 @end example
10770 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10771 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10772 working area.
10773
10774 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10775 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10776 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10777 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10778
10779 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10780 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10781
10782 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10783 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10784 @example
10785 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10786 @end example
10787
10788 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10789 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10790
10791 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10792 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10793 will be used.
10794
10795 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10796 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10797 @example
10798 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10799 @end example
10800 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10801
10802 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10803 can be used.
10804
10805 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10806 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10807 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10808
10809 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10810 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10811 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10812
10813 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10814 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10815 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10816 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10817 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10818 without any intrusion of the target process.
10819
10820 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10821 Place following command after target configuration:
10822 @example
10823 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10824 @end example
10825
10826 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10827 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10828 @example
10829 gdb_memory_map disable
10830 @end example
10831
10832 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10833 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10834 @example
10835 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10836 @end example
10837
10838 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10839 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10840
10841 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10842 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10843 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10844 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10845
10846 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10847 previously shown variables.
10848
10849 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10850 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10851 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10852 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10853 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10854
10855 @section RTOS Support
10856 @cindex RTOS Support
10857 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10858
10859 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10860 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10861
10862 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10863 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10864 GDB commands.
10865
10866 @* An example setup is below:
10867
10868 @example
10869 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10870 @end example
10871
10872 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10873
10874 Currently supported rtos's include:
10875 @itemize @bullet
10876 @item @option{eCos}
10877 @item @option{ThreadX}
10878 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10879 @item @option{linux}
10880 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10881 @item @option{embKernel}
10882 @item @option{mqx}
10883 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10884 @item @option{nuttx}
10885 @item @option{RIOT}
10886 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10887 @end itemize
10888
10889 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10890 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10891
10892 @table @code
10893 @item eCos symbols
10894 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10895 @item ThreadX symbols
10896 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10897 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10898 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10899 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10900 @tex
10901 \begingroup
10902 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10903 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10904 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10905 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10906 \par
10907 \endgroup
10908 @end tex
10909 @item linux symbols
10910 init_task.
10911 @item ChibiOS symbols
10912 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10913 @item embKernel symbols
10914 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10915 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10916 @item mqx symbols
10917 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10918 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10919 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10920 @item nuttx symbols
10921 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10922 @item RIOT symbols
10923 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10924 @end table
10925
10926 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10927 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10928
10929 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10930 along with the project:
10931
10932 @table @code
10933 @item FreeRTOS
10934 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10935 @item uC/OS-III
10936 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10937 @end table
10938
10939 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10940 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10941 @cindex SMP
10942 @cindex RTOS
10943 @cindex hwthread
10944 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10945 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10946 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10947 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10948 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10949 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10950 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10951 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10952 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10953
10954 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10955 @quotation Note
10956 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10957 @end quotation
10958
10959 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10960 @itemize @bullet
10961 @item j - smp status request
10962 @item J - smp set request
10963 @end itemize
10964
10965 OpenOCD implements :
10966 @itemize @bullet
10967 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10968 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10969 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10970 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10971 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10972 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10973 @end itemize
10974
10975 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10976 @itemize @bullet
10977 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10978 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10979 @example
10980 set $_core 1
10981 #Jc01 packet is sent
10982 print $_core
10983 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10984 @end example
10985
10986 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10987 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10988
10989 @example
10990 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10991 define toggle0
10992 maint packet Jc0
10993 continue
10994 main packet Jc-1
10995 end
10996 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10997 define toggle1
10998 maint packet Jc1
10999 continue
11000 main packet Jc-1
11001 end
11002 @end example
11003 @end itemize
11004
11005 @node Tcl Scripting API
11006 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11007 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11008 @cindex Tcl scripts
11009 @section API rules
11010
11011 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11012 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11013 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11014
11015 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11016 pair list and lists.
11017
11018 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11019 list.
11020
11021 @example
11022 > set foo(me) Duane
11023 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11024 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11025 > set foo(duck) Donald
11026 @end example
11027
11028 If one does this:
11029
11030 @example
11031 > set foo
11032 @end example
11033
11034 The result is:
11035
11036 @example
11037 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11038 @end example
11039
11040 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11041
11042 @verbatim
11043 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11044 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11045 }
11046 @end verbatim
11047
11048 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11049 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11050
11051 @section Internal low-level Commands
11052
11053 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11054 invoke directly.
11055
11056 @itemize @bullet
11057 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11058
11059 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11060 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11061
11062 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11063 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11064
11065 Return information about the flash banks
11066
11067 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11068
11069 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11070 its execution. Example:
11071
11072 @example
11073 > capture "reset init"
11074 @end example
11075
11076 @end itemize
11077
11078 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11079 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11080 called "flash_banks".
11081
11082 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11083
11084 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11085 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11086 holds one of the following values:
11087
11088 @itemize @bullet
11089 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11090 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11091 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11092 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11093 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11094 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11095 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11096 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11097 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11098 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11099 @end itemize
11100
11101 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11102
11103 @quotation Note
11104 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11105 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11106 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11107 is jim, not real tcl).
11108 @end quotation
11109
11110 @section Tcl RPC server
11111 @cindex RPC
11112
11113 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11114 commands and receive the results.
11115
11116 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11117 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11118 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11119 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11120 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11121
11122 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11123 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11124 @command{capture} command.
11125
11126 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11127
11128 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11129 @cindex RPC Notifications
11130
11131 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11132 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11133
11134 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11135 in the following format.
11136
11137 @verbatim
11138 type target_event event [event-name]
11139 type target_state state [state-name]
11140 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11141 @end verbatim
11142
11143 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11144 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11145 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11146 Defaults to off.
11147
11148 @end deffn
11149
11150 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11151 @cindex RPC trace output
11152
11153 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11154 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11155
11156 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11157
11158 @verbatim
11159 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11160 @end verbatim
11161
11162 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11163 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11164 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11165 Defaults to off.
11166
11167 See an example application here:
11168 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11169
11170 @end deffn
11171
11172 @node FAQ
11173 @chapter FAQ
11174 @cindex faq
11175 @enumerate
11176 @anchor{faqrtck}
11177 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11178 @cindex RTCK
11179 @cindex adaptive clocking
11180 @*
11181
11182 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11183 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11184 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11185 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11186
11187 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11188 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11189 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11190 @enumerate
11191 @item
11192 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11193 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11194 @item
11195 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11196 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11197 @end enumerate
11198
11199 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11200 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11201 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11202 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11203 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11204 power).
11205
11206 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11207 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11208 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11209 ARM926 scenario).
11210 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11211 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11212 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11213
11214 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11215 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11216 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11217 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11218
11219 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11220
11221 In order to make use of this,
11222 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11223 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11224
11225 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11226 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11227 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11228 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11229 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11230
11231 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11232 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11233 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11234 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11235
11236 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11237 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11238 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11239 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11240 with a CPLD.
11241 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11242 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11243 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11244 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11245 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11246 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11247
11248 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11249
11250 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11251
11252 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11253 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11254 depending on the chips on your board.
11255 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11256 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11257 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11258
11259 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11260 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11261 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11262
11263 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11264 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11265 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11266 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11267
11268 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11269 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11270 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11271 this way.
11272
11273 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11274 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11275 clock rate.
11276 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11277 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11278 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11279
11280 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11281
11282 @example
11283 # Example: 1.234MHz
11284 adapter speed 1234
11285 @end example
11286
11287
11288 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11289
11290 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11291 around Windows filenames.
11292
11293 @example
11294 > echo \a
11295
11296 > echo @{\a@}
11297 \a
11298 > echo "\a"
11299
11300 >
11301 @end example
11302
11303
11304 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11305
11306 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11307 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11308 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11309
11310 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11311 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11312 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11313
11314 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11315 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11316 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11317
11318 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11319
11320 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11321 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11322 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11323 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11324
11325 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11326 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11327 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11328
11329 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11330 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11331
11332 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11333 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11334 memory read caused data abort".
11335
11336 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11337 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11338 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11339 be done, feel free to add this here.
11340
11341 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11342 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11343 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11344 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11345 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11346 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11347 gracefully stops.
11348
11349 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11350 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11351 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11352
11353 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11354 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11355 bytes. Painful...
11356
11357
11358 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11359 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11360
11361 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11362 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11363 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11364 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11365 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11366 reset, everything else should work fine.
11367
11368 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11369 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11370 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11371 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11372
11373 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11374 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11375 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11376 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11377
11378 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11379
11380 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11381 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11382 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11383
11384 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11385 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11386
11387 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11388 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11389 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11390 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11391 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11392 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11393 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11394 clock frequency?
11395
11396 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11397 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11398 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11399 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11400 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11401
11402 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11403
11404 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11405 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11406 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11407 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11408 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11409 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11410 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11411
11412 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11413
11414 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11415 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11416 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11417 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11418
11419 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11420 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11421 particular order?
11422
11423 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11424 the same order used by the hardware.
11425
11426 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11427 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11428 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11429 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11430 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11431 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11432
11433 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11434 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11435 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11436 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11437
11438 @itemize @bullet
11439 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11440 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11441 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11442 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11443 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11444 @end itemize
11445
11446 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11447
11448 @itemize @bullet
11449 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11450 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11451 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11452 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11453 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11454 @end itemize
11455
11456
11457 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11458 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11459 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11460
11461 TODO.
11462
11463 @end enumerate
11464
11465 @node Tcl Crash Course
11466 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11467 @cindex Tcl
11468
11469 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11470 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11471 how the Tcl scripts work.
11472
11473 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11474 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11475 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11476 OpenOCD.
11477
11478 @section Tcl Rule #1
11479 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11480 @enumerate
11481 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11482 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11483 @end enumerate
11484
11485 The Tcl equal is this:
11486
11487 @enumerate
11488 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11489 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11490 @end enumerate
11491
11492 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11493 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11494
11495 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11496 There is a second pair of rules.
11497 @enumerate
11498 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11499 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11500 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11501 in Tcl.
11502 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11503 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11504 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11505 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11506 @end enumerate
11507
11508 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11509 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11510 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11511 Everything is a string}
11512
11513 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11514 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11515 difference is subtle.
11516 @enumerate
11517 @item Parse Time
11518 @item Evaluation Time
11519 @end enumerate
11520
11521 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11522 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11523 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11524
11525 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11526 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11527 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11528 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11529
11530 @itemize @bullet
11531 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11532 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11533 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11534 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11535 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11536 @example
11537 # bash example
11538 X=`date`
11539 echo "The Date is: $X"
11540 # Tcl example
11541 set X [date]
11542 puts "The Date is: $X"
11543 @end example
11544 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11545 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11546 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11547 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11548 is a string}
11549 @example
11550 set x "Dinner"
11551 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11552 @end example
11553 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11554 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11555 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11556 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11557 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11558 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11559 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11560 @end itemize
11561
11562 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11563
11564 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11565
11566 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11567
11568 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11569 the normal way.
11570
11571 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11572 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11573 line is immediately executed.
11574
11575 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11576 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11577
11578 @subsection Command Execution
11579
11580 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11581 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11582 control flow operators.
11583
11584 Commands are executed like this:
11585
11586 @enumerate
11587 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11588 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11589 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11590 @end enumerate
11591
11592 It sort of works like this:
11593 @example
11594 for(;;)@{
11595 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11596
11597 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11598
11599 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11600 @}
11601 @end example
11602
11603 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11604 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11605 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11606 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11607 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11608 ``LookupCommand()''
11609
11610 @subsection The FOR command
11611
11612 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11613 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11614 command just like any other command.
11615
11616 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11617 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11618 are:
11619
11620 @enumerate 0
11621 @item The ascii text 'for'
11622 @item The start text
11623 @item The test expression
11624 @item The next text
11625 @item The body text
11626 @end enumerate
11627
11628 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11629 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11630 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11631 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11632
11633 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11634 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11635
11636 @example
11637 int
11638 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11639 int *argc,
11640 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11641 @end example
11642
11643 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11644 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11645 still operates in the same basic way.
11646
11647 @subsection FOR command implementation
11648
11649 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11650 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11651
11652 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11653
11654 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11655
11656 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11657 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11658 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11659
11660 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11661 expression and returns a value.
11662
11663 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11664 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11665 @example
11666 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11667
11668 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11669
11670 int
11671 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11672 int argc,
11673 char **argv )
11674 @{
11675 if( argc != 5 )@{
11676 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11677 return ERROR;
11678 @}
11679
11680 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11681
11682 // Execute the start statement.
11683 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11684
11685 // Top of loop test
11686 for(;;)@{
11687 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11688 if( i == 0 )
11689 break;
11690
11691 // Execute the body
11692 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11693
11694 // Execute the LOOP part
11695 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11696 @}
11697
11698 // Return no error
11699 SetResult( interp, "" );
11700 return SUCCESS;
11701 @}
11702 @end example
11703
11704 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11705 in the same basic way.
11706
11707 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11708
11709 @subsection source and find commands
11710 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11711 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11712 @*Remember the parsing rules
11713 @enumerate
11714 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11715 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11716 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11717 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11718 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11719 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11720 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11721 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11722 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11723 @end enumerate
11724 @subsection format command
11725 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11726 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11727 @b{sprintf()}.
11728 @b{Example}
11729 @example
11730 set x 6
11731 set y 7
11732 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11733 @end example
11734 @enumerate
11735 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11736 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11737 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11738 @* Refer to Rule #1
11739 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11740 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11741 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11742 @end enumerate
11743 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11744 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11745 @example
11746 #1 Good
11747 proc someproc @{@} @{
11748 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11749 @}
11750 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11751 #2 Good - no variables
11752 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11753 #3 Good Curly Braces
11754 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11755 puts "Time: [date]"
11756 @}
11757 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11758 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11759 @end example
11760 @enumerate
11761 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11762 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11763 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11764 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11765 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11766 command.
11767 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11768 @*There are 4 examples:
11769 @enumerate
11770 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11771 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11772 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11773 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11774 @end enumerate
11775
11776 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11777 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11778 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11779
11780 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11781 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11782 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11783 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11784 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11785 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11786 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11787 @end enumerate
11788 @subsection Global Variables
11789 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11790 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11791 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11792 @example
11793 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11794 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11795 global x #Global variable X
11796 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11797 @}
11798 @end example
11799 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11800 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11801 @example
11802 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11803 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11804 # Create var name
11805 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11806 # Make it a global
11807 global $vn
11808 # Set it.
11809 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11810 @}
11811 @end example
11812 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11813 @example
11814 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11815 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11816 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11817 @}
11818 @end example
11819
11820 @include fdl.texi
11821
11822 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11823 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11824 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11825 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11826 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11827 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11828
11829 @printindex cp
11830
11831 @node Command and Driver Index
11832 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11833 @printindex fn
11834
11835 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)